Holtek HT69F40A Tinypowertm i/o flash 8-bit mcu with lcd & eeprom Datasheet

TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Revision: V1.00
Date: ��������������
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Table of Contents
Features............................................................................................................. 6
CPU Features.......................................................................................................................... 6
Peripheral Features.................................................................................................................. 6
General Description.......................................................................................... 7
Selection Table.................................................................................................. 7
Block Diagram................................................................................................... 8
Pin Assignment................................................................................................. 9
Pin Description............................................................................................... 13
Absolute Maximum Ratings........................................................................... 24
D.C. Characteristics........................................................................................ 25
A.C. Characteristics........................................................................................ 28
LVD & LVR Electrical Characteristics........................................................... 29
LCD D.C. Characteristics............................................................................... 30
Power-on Reset Characteristics.................................................................... 31
System Architecture....................................................................................... 31
Clocking and Pipelining.......................................................................................................... 31
Program Counter.................................................................................................................... 32
Stack...................................................................................................................................... 33
Arithmetic and Logic Unit – ALU............................................................................................ 33
Flash Program Memory.................................................................................. 34
Structure................................................................................................................................. 34
Special Vectors...................................................................................................................... 35
Look-up Table......................................................................................................................... 35
Table Program Example......................................................................................................... 35
In Circuit Programming – ICP................................................................................................ 36
On-Chip Debug Support – OCDS.......................................................................................... 37
Data Memory................................................................................................... 38
Structure................................................................................................................................. 38
General Purpose Data Memory............................................................................................. 39
Special Purpose Data Memory.............................................................................................. 39
Special Function Register Description......................................................... 43
Indirect Addressing Registers – IAR0, IAR1.......................................................................... 43
Memory Pointers – MP0, MP1............................................................................................... 43
Bank Pointer – BP.................................................................................................................. 44
Accumulator – ACC................................................................................................................ 45
Program Counter Low Register – PCL................................................................................... 45
Look-up Table Registers – TBLP, TBHP, TBLH...................................................................... 45
Status Register – STATUS..................................................................................................... 46
Rev. 1.00
2
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
EEPROM Data Memory................................................................................... 48
EEPROM Registers............................................................................................................... 48
Reading Data from the EEPROM.......................................................................................... 50
Writing Data to the EEPROM................................................................................................. 50
Write Protection...................................................................................................................... 50
EEPROM Interrupt................................................................................................................. 50
Programming Considerations................................................................................................. 51
Oscillator......................................................................................................... 52
Oscillator Overview................................................................................................................ 52
System Clock Configurations................................................................................................. 52
External Crystal/Ceramic Oscillator – HXT............................................................................ 53
External RC Oscillator – ERC................................................................................................ 54
Internal RC Oscillator – HIRC................................................................................................ 54
External 32.768kHz Crystal Oscillator – LXT......................................................................... 55
LXT Oscillator Low Power Function....................................................................................... 56
Internal 32kHz Oscillator – LIRC............................................................................................ 56
External Clock – EC............................................................................................................... 56
Supplementary Oscillators..................................................................................................... 56
Operating Modes and System Clocks.......................................................... 57
System Clock......................................................................................................................... 57
System Operation Modes....................................................................................................... 58
Control Register..................................................................................................................... 59
Fast Wake-up......................................................................................................................... 61
Operating Mode Switching..................................................................................................... 61
Operating Mode Switching and Wake-up............................................................................... 62
NORMAL Mode to SLOW Mode Switching............................................................................ 63
SLOW Mode to NORMAL Mode Switching............................................................................ 64
Entering the SLEEP0 Mode................................................................................................... 65
Entering the SLEEP1 Mode................................................................................................... 65
Entering the IDLE0 Mode....................................................................................................... 65
Entering the IDLE1 Mode....................................................................................................... 66
Standby Current Considerations............................................................................................ 66
Wake-up................................................................................................................................. 67
Programming Considerations................................................................................................. 67
Watchdog Timer.............................................................................................. 68
Watchdog Timer Clock Source............................................................................................... 68
Watchdog Timer Control Register.......................................................................................... 68
Watchdog Timer Operation.................................................................................................... 69
Reset and Initialisation................................................................................... 70
Reset Functions..................................................................................................................... 71
Reset Initial Conditions.......................................................................................................... 74
Rev. 1.00
3
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Input/Output Ports.......................................................................................... 78
I/O Port Register List.............................................................................................................. 78
Pull-high Resistors................................................................................................................. 81
Port A Wake-up...................................................................................................................... 81
I/O Port Control Registers...................................................................................................... 81
Pin-shared Functions............................................................................................................. 81
I/O Pin Structures................................................................................................................... 92
Programming Considerations................................................................................................. 92
Timer Modules – TM....................................................................................... 93
Introduction............................................................................................................................ 93
TM Operation......................................................................................................................... 93
TM Clock Source.................................................................................................................... 94
TM Interrupts.......................................................................................................................... 94
TM External Pins.................................................................................................................... 94
TM Input/Output Pin Control Registers.................................................................................. 95
Programming Considerations............................................................................................... 101
Compact Type TM – CTM............................................................................. 102
Compact TM Operation........................................................................................................ 102
Compact Type TM Register Description.............................................................................. 103
Compact Type TM Operating Modes................................................................................... 107
Compare Match Output Mode.............................................................................................. 107
Timer/Counter Mode.............................................................................................................110
PWM Output Mode................................................................................................................110
Standard Type TM – STM..............................................................................113
Standard TM Operation.........................................................................................................113
Standard Type TM Register Description...............................................................................114
Standard Type TM Operating Modes................................................................................... 123
Compare Output Mode......................................................................................................... 123
Timer/Counter Mode............................................................................................................ 126
PWM Output Mode............................................................................................................... 126
Single Pulse Mode............................................................................................................... 130
Capture Input Mode............................................................................................................. 132
Enhanced Type TM – ETM............................................................................ 134
Enhanced TM Operation...................................................................................................... 134
Enhanced Type TM Register Description............................................................................. 135
Enhanced Type TM Operating Modes................................................................................. 142
Compare Output Mode......................................................................................................... 142
Timer/Counter Mode............................................................................................................ 147
PWM Output Mode............................................................................................................... 147
Single Pulse Output Mode................................................................................................... 153
Capture Input Mode............................................................................................................. 155
Rev. 1.00
4
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Interrupts....................................................................................................... 158
Interrupt Registers................................................................................................................ 158
Interrupt Operation............................................................................................................... 164
External Interrupt.................................................................................................................. 166
Multi-function Interrupt......................................................................................................... 166
Time Base Interrupt.............................................................................................................. 167
EEPROM Interrupt............................................................................................................... 168
LVD Interrupt........................................................................................................................ 168
TM Interrupts........................................................................................................................ 168
Interrupt Wake-up Function.................................................................................................. 169
Programming Considerations............................................................................................... 169
Low Voltage Detector – LVD........................................................................ 170
LVD Register........................................................................................................................ 170
LVD Operation...................................................................................................................... 171
LCD Driver..................................................................................................... 172
LCD Memory........................................................................................................................ 172
LCD Register........................................................................................................................ 174
LCD Reset Function............................................................................................................. 175
Clock Source........................................................................................................................ 175
LCD Driver Output................................................................................................................ 175
LCD Voltage Source Biasing................................................................................................ 176
LCD Waveform Timing Diagram.......................................................................................... 177
Programming Considerations............................................................................................... 182
Configuration Options.................................................................................. 183
Application Circuits...................................................................................... 184
Instruction Set............................................................................................... 185
Introduction.......................................................................................................................... 185
Instruction Timing................................................................................................................. 185
Moving and Transferring Data.............................................................................................. 185
Arithmetic Operations........................................................................................................... 185
Logical and Rotate Operations............................................................................................. 186
Branches and Control Transfer............................................................................................ 186
Bit Operations...................................................................................................................... 186
Table Read Operations........................................................................................................ 186
Other Operations.................................................................................................................. 186
Instruction Set Summary............................................................................. 187
Table conventions................................................................................................................ 187
Instruction Definition.................................................................................... 189
Package Information.................................................................................... 198
48-pin LQFP (7mm×7mm) Outline Dimensions................................................................... 199
64-pin LQFP (7mm×7mm) Outline Dimensions................................................................... 200
80-pin LQFP (10mm×10mm) Outline Dimensions............................................................... 201
Rev. 1.00
5
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Features
CPU Features
• Operating voltage:
♦♦
fSYS=4MHz: 2.2V~5.5V
♦♦
fSYS=8MHz: 2.4V~5.5V
♦♦
fSYS=12MHz: 2.7V~5.5V
♦♦
fSYS=20MHz: 4.5V~5.5V
• Up to 0.2μs instruction cycle with 20MHz system clock at VDD=5V
• Power down and wake-up functions to reduce power consumption
• Oscillator types:
♦♦
External Crystal – HXT
♦♦
External 32.765kHz Crystal – LXT
♦♦
External RC – ERC
♦♦
External Clock – EC
♦♦
Internal RC – HIRC
♦♦
Internal 32kHz RC – LIRC
• Multi-mode operation: NORMAL, SLOW, IDLE and SLEEP
• Fully integrated internal 4MHz, 8MHz and 12MHz oscillator requires no external components
• All instructions executed in one or two instruction cycles
• Table read instructions
• 63 powerful instructions
• Up to 8-level subroutine nesting
• Bit manipulation instruction
Peripheral Features
• Flash Program Memory: 2K×16~8K×16
• Data Memory: 128×8~384×8
• EEPROM Memory: 64×8~128×8
• Watchdog Timer function
• Up to 52 bidirectional I/O lines
• LCD driver function
• Multiple pin-shared external interrupts
• Multiple Timer Module for time measure, input capture, compare match output, PWM output or
single pulse output function
• Dual Time-Base functions for generation of fixed time interrupt signals
• Low voltage reset function
• Low voltage detect function
• Wide range of available package types
Rev. 1.00
6
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
General Description
The HT69Fx0A series of devices are Flash Memory LCD type 8-bit high performance RISC
architecture microcontrollers, designed for applications which require an LCD interface. Offering
users the convenience of Flash Memory multi-programming features, these devices also include a
wide range of functions and features. Other memory includes an area of RAM Data Memory.
Analog features include multiple and extremely flexible Timer Modules provide timing, pulse
generation and PWM generation functions. Protective features such as an internal Watchdog Timer,
Low Voltage Reset and Low Voltage Detector coupled with excellent noise immunity and ESD
protection ensure that reliable operation is maintained in hostile electrical environments.
A full choice of internal and external oscillator functions are provided including fully integrated low
and high speed system oscillators which requires no external components for their implementation. The
ability to operate and switch dynamically between a range of operating modes using different clock
sources gives users the ability to optimise microcontroller operation and minimise power consumption.
The inclusion of flexible I/O programming features, Time-Base functions along with many other
features ensure that the devices will find excellent use in applications such as consumer products,
handheld instruments, household appliances, electronically controlled tools and motor driving in
addition to many others.
Selection Table
Most features are common to all devices. The main features distinguishing them are Memory
capacity, I/O count, TM features, stack capacity, LCD driver and package types. The following table
summarises the main features of each device.
Part No.
Program
Data
Data
External LCD
I/O
Memory Memory EEPROM
Interrupt Driver
Timer
Module
Time
Stacks
Base
Package
HT69F30A
2k×16
128×8
64×8
39
2
24×4 10-bit CTM×1
25×3 10-bit STM×1
2
4
48LQFP
HT69F40A
4k×16
256×8
128×8
51
2
10-bit CTM×1
36×4
10-bit STM×1
37×3
10-bit ETM×1
2
8
48/64LQFP
HT69F50A
8k×16
384×8
128×8
63
2
10-bit CTM×1
48×4
16-bit STM×1
49×3
10-bit ETM×1
2
8
48/64/80LQFP
Note: As devices exist in more than one package format, the table reflects the situation for the package with the
most pins.
Rev. 1.00
7
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Block Diagram
Low
Voltage
Detect
Low
Voltage
Reset
I/O
Rev. 1.00
LCD
Driver
Reset
Circuit
8-bit
RISC
MCU
Core
Stack
Flash/EEPROM
Programming
Circuitry (ICP)/OCDS
Flash
Program
Memory
Watchdog
Timer
EEPROM
Data
Memory
TM0
RAM
Data
Memory
Time
Base
Interrupt
Controller
ERC/EC/HXT
Oscillator
HIRC
Oscillator
LIRC/LXT
Oscillator
TMn
TM1
8
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Pin Assignment
PA6/TP0_0
PA5/TP1_1
PA4/INT0
PA3/TP1_0
PA2/TCK0/TCK1
PA0/INT1
PA1/TP0_1
PB1/OSC2
PB0/OSC1
VDD
VSS
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
VLCD
VMAX
V1
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3/SEG24
PF7/SEG23
48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37
1
36
2
35
3
34
4
33
5
32
6
HT69F30A
31
7
30
48 LQFP-A
8
29
9
28
10
27
11
26
12
25
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
PA7/RES
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK1
PD3/SEG3
PD4/SEG4
PD5/SEG5
PD6/SEG6
PD7/SEG7
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
HT69F30A 48 LQFP- A
PA6/TP0_0
PA5/TP2_1
PA4/INT0
PA3/TP2_0
PA2/TCK0/TCK2
PA0/INT1/TCK1
PA1/TP0_1
PB1/OSC2
PB0/OSC1
VDD
VSS
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
VLCD
VMAX
V1
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3/SEG24
PF7/SEG23
48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37
1
36
2
35
3
34
4
33
5
32
6
HT69F40A
31
7
30
48 LQFP-A
8
29
9
28
10
27
11
26
12
25
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
PA7/RES
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK2
PD3/SEG3/TCK1
PD4/SEG4/TP1A
PD5/SEG5/TP1B_0
PD6/SEG6/TP1B_1
PD7/SEG7/TP1B_2
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
HT69F40A 48 LQFP- A
Rev. 1.00
9
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PA6/TP0_0
PA5/TP2_1
PA4/INT0
PA3/TP2_0
PA2/TCK0/TCK2
PA0/INT1/TCK1
PA1/TP0_1
PB7/TP1B_2
PB6/TP1B_1
PB5/TP1B_0
PB4/TP1A
PB1/OSC2
PB0/OSC1
VDD
VSS
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
VLCD
VMAX
V1
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3/SEG36
SEG35
SEG34
SEG33
SEG32
PG7/SEG31
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
48
1
2
47
3
46
4
45
5
44
6
43
7
42
8
41
HT69F40A
9
40
64 LQFP-A
10
39
11
38
12
37
13
36
14
35
15
34
33
16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
PA7/RES
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK2
PD3/SEG3/TCK1
PD4/SEG4/TP1A
PD5/SEG5/TP1B_0
PD6/SEG6/TP1B_1
PD7/SEG7/TP1B_2
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
PF7/SEG23
PG0/SEG24
PG1/SEG25
PG2/SEG26
PG3/SEG27
PG4/SEG28
PG5/SEG29
PG6/SEG30
HT69F40A 64 LQFP- A
PA6/TP0_0
PA5/TP2_1
PA4/INT0
PA3/TP2_0
PA2/TCK0/TCK2
PA0/INT1/TCK1
PA1/TP0_1
PB1/OSC2
PB0/OSC1
VDD
VSS
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
PLCD
VMAX
V1
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3/SEG24
PF7/SEG23
48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37
1
36
2
35
3
34
4
33
5
32
6
HT69F50A
31
7
30
48 LQFP-A
8
29
9
28
10
27
11
26
12
25
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
PA7/RES
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK2
PD3/SEG3/TCK1
PD4/SEG4/TP1A
PD5/SEG5/TP1B_0
PD6/SEG6/TP1B_1
PD7/SEG7/TP1B_2
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
HT69F50A 48 LQFP- A
Rev. 1.00
10
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PA6/TP0_0
PA5/TP2_1
PA4/INT0
PA3/TP2_0
PA2/TCK0/TCK2
PA0/INT1/TCK1
PA1/TP0_1
PB7/TP1B_2
PB6/TP1B_1
PB5/TP1B_0
PB4/TP1A
PB1/OSC2
PB0/OSC1
VDD
VSS
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
PLCD
VMAX
V1
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3/SEG36
PH3/SEG35
PH2/SEG34
PH1/SEG33
PH0/SEG32
PG7/SEG31
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
48
1
2
47
3
46
4
45
5
44
6
43
7
42
8
41
HT69F50A
9
40
64 LQFP-A
10
39
11
38
12
37
13
36
14
35
15
34
33
16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
PA7/RES
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK2
PD3/SEG3/TCK1
PD4/SEG4/TP1A
PD5/SEG5/TP1B_0
PD6/SEG6/TP1B_1
PD7/SEG7/TP1B_2
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
PF7/SEG23
PG0/SEG24
PG1/SEG25
PG2/SEG26
PG3/SEG27
PG4/SEG28
PG5/SEG29
PG6/SEG30
HT69F50A 64 LQFP- A
PA6/TP0_0
PA5/TP2_1
PA4/INT0
PA3/TP2_0
PA2/TCK0/TCK2
PA0/INT1/TCK1
PA1/TP0_1
PB7/TP1B_2
PB6/TP1B_1
PC6
PC5
PC4
PC3
PB5/TP1B_0
PB4/TP1A
PB1/OSC2
PB0/OSC1
VDD
VSS
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
VLCD
VMAX
V1
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3/SEG48
SEG47
SEG46
SEG45
SEG44
SEG43
SEG42
SEG41
SEG40
PH7/SEG39
80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 6766 65 6463 62 61
1
60
2
59
3
58
4
57
5
56
6
55
7
54
8
53
9
52
10
51
HT69F50A
11
40
80 LQFP-A
12
49
13
48
47
14
46
15
45
16
17
44
18
43
19
42
20
41
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 3435 36 3738 39 40
PA7/RES
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK2
PD3/SEG3/TCK1
PD4/SEG4/TP1A
PD5/SEG5/TP1B_0
PD6/SEG6/TP1B_1
PD7/SEG7/TP1B_2
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
PF7/SEG23
PG0/SEG24
PG1/SEG25
PG2/SEG26
PG3/SEG27
PG4/SEG28
PG5/SEG29
PG6/SEG30
PG7/SEG31
PH0/SEG32
PH1/SEG33
PH2/SEG34
PH3/SEG35
PH4/SEG36
PH5/SEG37
PH6/SEG38
HT69F50A 80 LQFP- A
Rev. 1.00
11
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PA6/TP0_0
PA5/TP2_1
PA4/INT0
PA3/TP2_0
PA2/TCK0/TCK2/ICPCK/OCDSCK
PA0/INT1/TCK1/ICPDA/OCDSDA
PA1/TP0_1
PB7/TP1B_2
PB6/TP1B_1
PC6
PC5
PC4
PC3
PB5/TP1B_0
PB4/TP1A
PB1/OSC2
PB0/OSC1
VDD
VSS
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
VLCD
VMAX
V1
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM3/SEG48
SEG47
SEG46
SEG45
SEG44
SEG43
SEG42
SEG41
SEG40
PH7/SEG39
80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 6766 65 6463 62 61
1
60
2
59
3
58
4
57
5
56
6
55
7
54
8
53
9
52
10
51
HT69V50A
11
40
80 LQFP-A
12
49
13
48
47
14
46
15
45
16
17
44
18
43
19
42
20
41
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 3435 36 3738 39 40
PA7/RES
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK2
PD3/SEG3/TCK1
PD4/SEG4/TP1A
PD5/SEG5/TP1B_0
PD6/SEG6/TP1B_1
PD7/SEG7/TP1B_2
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
PF7/SEG23
PG0/SEG24
PG1/SEG25
PG2/SEG26
PG3/SEG27
PG4/SEG28
PG5/SEG29
PG6/SEG30
PG7/SEG31
PH0/SEG32
PH1/SEG33
PH2/SEG34
PH3/SEG35
PH4/SEG36
PH5/SEG37
PH6/SEG38
HT69V50A 80 LQFP- A
Note: 1. If the pin-shared pin functions have multiple outputs simultaneously, the output function is determined by
the corresponding software control bits except the functions determined by the configuration options.
2. The HT69V50A device is the EV chip of the HT69Fx0A series of devices. It supports the “On-Chip
Debug” function for debugging during development using the OCDSDA and OCDSCK pins connected to
the Holtek HT-IDE development tools.
Rev. 1.00
12
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Pin Description
HT69F30A
Pad Name
PA0/INT1/ICPDA
/OCDSDA
PA1/TP0_1
PA2/TCK0/TCK1
/ICPCK/OCDSCK
PA3/TP1_0
Function
OPT
I/T
PA0
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
INT1
INTEG
INTC0
SFS
ST
ICPDA
—
ST
CMOS ICP Data/Address
OCDSDA
—
ST
CMOS OCDS Data/Address
PA1
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP0_1
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM0 I/O pin
PA2
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TCK0
SFS
ST
—
TM0 input
TCK1
SFS
ST
—
TM1 input
ICPCK
—
ST
OCDSCK
—
ST
PA3
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP1_0
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PA4
PAPU
PAWU
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
INT0
INTEG
INTC0
ST
PA5
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP1_1
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PA6
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP0_0
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM0 I/O pin
PA7
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
RES
CO
ST
PA4/INT0
PA5/TP1_1
PA6/TP0_0
PA7/RES
PB0/OSC1
PB1/OSC2
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
Rev. 1.00
PB0
PBPU
ST
OSC1
CO
HXT
PB1
PBPU
ST
OSC2
CO
—
PB2
PBPU
ST
XT1
CO
LXT
PB3
PBPU
ST
XT2
CO
—
O/T
Description
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
—
External Interrupt 1
CMOS ICP Clock pin
—
—
—
OCDS Clock pin
External Interrupt 0
Reset pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
—
HXT/ERC oscillator pin & EC mode input pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
HXT
HXT oscillator pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
—
LXT oscillator pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
LXT
LXT oscillator pin
13
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Pad Name
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK1
PD3/SEG3
PD4/SEG4
PD5/SEG5
PD6/SEG6
PD7/SEG7
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
Rev. 1.00
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Function
OPT
I/T
PC0
PCPU
PCFS
O/T
Description
ST
V2
PCFS
—
PC1
PCPU
PCFS
ST
C1
PCFS
—
PC2
PCPU
PCFS
ST
C2
PCFS
—
PD0
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG0
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
INT1
INTEG
INTC0
SFS
ST
—
External Interrupt 1
PD1
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG1
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
TCK0
SFS
ST
—
TM0 input
PD2
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG2
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
TCK1
SFS
ST
—
TM1 input
PD3
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG3
PDFS
—
PD4
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG4
PDFS
—
PD5
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG5
PDFS
—
PD6
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG6
PDFS
—
PD7
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG7
PDFS
—
PE0
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG8
PEFS
—
PE1
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG9
PEFS
—
PE2
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG10
PEFS
—
PE3
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG11
PEFS
—
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD voltage pump
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD voltage pump
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD voltage pump
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
14
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Pad Name
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
PF7/SEG23
COM0~COM2
COM3/SEG24
V1
Function
OPT
I/T
PE4
PEPU
PEFS
O/T
Description
ST
SEG12
PEFS
—
PE5
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG13
PEFS
—
PE6
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG14
PEFS
—
PE7
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG15
PEFS
—
PF0
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG16
PFFS
—
PF1
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG17
PFFS
—
PF2
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG18
PFFS
—
PF3
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG19
PFFS
—
PF4
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG20
PFFS
—
PF5
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG21
PFFS
—
PF6
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG22
PFFS
—
PF7
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG23
PFFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
COMn
—
—
AO
LCD common outputs
COM3
—
—
AO
LCD common output
SEG24
LCDC
—
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
V1
—
—
AO
LCD voltage pump
VLCD
VLCD
—
PWR
—
LCD power supply
VMAX
VMAX
—
PWR
—
IC maximum voltage, connected to VDD, VLCD or V1
VDD
VDD
—
PWR
—
Positive Power supply
VSS
VSS
—
PWR
—
Negative Power supply. Ground
Note: I/T: Input type;
O/T: Output type
OPT: Optional by configuration option (CO) or register option
PWR: Power;
CO: Configuration option
ST: Schmitt Trigger input;
AO: Analog output
CMOS: CMOS output;
NMOS: NMOS output
HXT: High frequency crystal oscillator
LXT: High frequency crystal oscillator
Rev. 1.00
15
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
HT69F40A
Pad Name
PA0/INT1
/TCK1/ICPDA
/OCDSDA
PA1/TP0_1
PA2/TCK0
/TCK2/ICPCK
/OCDSCK
PA3/TP2_0
Function
OPT
I/T
PA0
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
INT1
INTEG
INTC0
SFS
ST
TCK1
SFS
ST
ICPDA
—
ST
CMOS ICP Data/Address
OCDSDA
—
ST
CMOS OCDS Data/Address
PA1
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP0_1
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM0 I/O pin
PA2
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TCK0
SFS
ST
—
TM0 input
TCK2
SFS
ST
—
TM2 input
PA6/TP0_0
PA7/RES
PB0/OSC1
PB1/OSC2
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
PB4/TP1A
Rev. 1.00
Description
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
—
External Interrupt 1
—
TM1 input
ICPCK
—
ST
OCDSCK
—
ST
PA3
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP2_0
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM2 I/O pin
PA4
PAPU
PAWU
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
INT0
INTEG
INTC0
ST
PA5
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP2_1
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM2 I/O pin
PA6
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP0_0
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM0 I/O pin
PA7
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
RES
CO
ST
PB0
PBPU
ST
OSC1
CO
HXT
PB1
PBPU
ST
PA4/INT0
PA5/TP2_1
O/T
CMOS ICP Clock pin
—
—
—
OCDS Clock pin
External Interrupt 0
Reset pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
—
HXT/ERC oscillator pin & EC mode input pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
OSC2
CO
—
PB2
PBPU
ST
HXT
HXT oscillator pin
XT1
CO
LXT
PB3
PBPU
ST
XT2
CO
—
PB1
PBPU
PBFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
TP1A
PBFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
—
LXT oscillator pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
LXT
LXT oscillator pin
16
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Pad Name
PB5/TP1B_0
PB6/TP1B_1
PB7/TP1B_2
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK2
PD3/SEG3/TCK1
PD4/SEG4/TP1A
PD5/SEG5
/TP1B_0
Rev. 1.00
Function
OPT
I/T
PB5
PBPU
PBFS
O/T
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
TP1B_0
PBFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PB6
PBPU
PBFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
TP1B_1
PBFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PB7
PBPU
PBFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
TP1B_2
PBFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PC0
PCPU
PCFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
V2
PCFS
—
PC1
PCPU
PCFS
ST
C1
PCFS
—
PC2
PCPU
PCFS
ST
C2
PCFS
—
PD0
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG0
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
INT1
INTEG
INTC0
SFS
ST
—
External Interrupt 1
PD1
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG1
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
TCK0
SFS
ST
—
TM0 input
PD2
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG2
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
TCK2
SFS
ST
—
TM2 input
PD3
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG3
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
TCK1
SFS
ST
—
TM1 input
PD4
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG4
PDFS
SFS
—
TP1A
PDFS
SFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PD5
PDPU
PDFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
SEG5
PDFS
SFS
—
TP1B_0
PDFS
SFS
ST
AO
Description
LCD voltage pump
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD voltage pump
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD voltage pump
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up.
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
AO
LCD segment output
LCD segment output
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
17
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Pad Name
PD6/SEG6
/TP1B_1
PD7/SEG7
/TP1B_2
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
Rev. 1.00
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Function
OPT
I/T
PD6
PDPU
PDFS
O/T
Description
ST
SEG6
PDFS
SFS
—
TP1B_1
PDFS
SFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PD7
PDPU
PDFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
SEG7
PDFS
SFS
—
TP1B_2
PDFS
SFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PE0
PEPU
PEFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
SEG8
PEFS
—
PE1
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG9
PEFS
—
PE2
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG10
PEFS
—
PE3
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG11
PEFS
—
PE4
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG12
PEFS
—
PE5
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG13
PEFS
—
PE6
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG14
PEFS
—
PE7
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG15
PEFS
—
PF0
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG16
PFFS
—
PF1
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG17
PFFS
—
PF2
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG18
PFFS
—
PF3
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG19
PFFS
—
PF4
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG20
PFFS
—
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
AO
AO
LCD segment output
LCD segment output
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
18
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Pad Name
Function
OPT
I/T
PF5
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG21
PFFS
—
PF6
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG22
PFFS
—
PF7
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG23
PFFS
—
PG0
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG24
PGFS
—
PG1
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG25
PGFS
—
PG2
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG26
PGFS
—
PG3
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG27
PGFS
—
PG4
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG28
PGFS
—
PG5
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG29
PGFS
—
PG6
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG30
PGFS
—
PG7
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG31
PGFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
SEG32~SEG35
SEGn
—
—
AO
LCD segment outputs
COM0~COM2
COMn
—
—
AO
LCD common outputs
COM3
—
—
AO
LCD common output
SEG36
LCDC
—
AO
LCD segment output
V1
—
—
AO
LCD voltage pump
VLCD
VLCD
—
PWR
—
LCD power supply
VMAX
VMAX
—
PWR
—
IC maximum voltage, connected to VDD, VLCD or V1
VDD
VDD
—
PWR
—
Positive Power supply
VSS
VSS
—
PWR
—
Negative Power supply. Ground
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
PF7/SEG23
PG0/SEG24
PG1/SEG25
PG2/SEG26
PG3/SEG27
PG4/SEG28
PG5/SEG29
PG6/SEG30
PG7/SEG31
COM3/SEG36
V1
O/T
Description
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
Note: I/T: Input type;
O/T: Output type
OPT: Optional by configuration option (CO) or register option
PWR: Power;
CO: Configuration option
ST: Schmitt Trigger input;
AO: Analog output
CMOS: CMOS output;
NMOS: NMOS output
HXT: High frequency crystal oscillator
LXT: High frequency crystal oscillator
Rev. 1.00
19
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
HT69F50A
Pad Name
PA0/INT1
/TCK1/ICPDA
/OCDSDA
PA1/TP0_1
PA2/TCK0
/TCK2/ICPCK
/OCDSCK
PA3/TP2_0
Function
OPT
I/T
PA0
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
INT1
INTEG
INTC0
SFS
ST
TCK1
SFS
ST
ICPDA
—
ST
CMOS ICP Data/Address
OCDSDA
—
ST
CMOS OCDS Data/Address
PA1
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP0_1
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM0 I/O pin
PA2
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TCK0
SFS
ST
—
TM0 input
TCK2
SFS
ST
—
TM2 input
PA6/TP0_0
PA7/RES
PB0/OSC1
PB1/OSC2
PB2/XT1
PB3/XT2
PB4/TP1A
Rev. 1.00
Description
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
—
External Interrupt 1
—
TM1 input
ICPCK
—
ST
OCDSCK
—
ST
PA3
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP2_0
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM2 I/O pin
PA4
PAPU
PAWU
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
INT0
INTEG
INTC0
ST
PA5
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP2_1
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM2 I/O pin
PA6
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
TP0_0
PAFS
ST
CMOS TM0 I/O pin
PA7
PAWU
PAPU
PAFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up and wake-up
RES
CO
ST
PB0
PBPU
ST
OSC1
CO
HXT
PB1
PBPU
ST
PA4/INT0
PA5/TP2_1
O/T
CMOS ICP Clock pin
—
—
—
OCDS Clock pin
External Interrupt 0
Reset pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
—
HXT/ERC oscillator pin & EC mode input pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
OSC2
CO
—
PB2
PBPU
ST
HXT
HXT oscillator pin
XT1
CO
LXT
PB3
PBPU
ST
XT2
CO
—
PB1
PBPU
PBFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
TP1A
PBFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
—
LXT oscillator pin
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
LXT
LXT oscillator pin
20
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Pad Name
PB5/TP1B_0
PB6/TP1B_1
PB7/TP1B_2
PC0/V2
PC1/C1
PC2/C2
PC3~PC6
PD0/SEG0/INT1
PD1/SEG1/TCK0
PD2/SEG2/TCK2
PD3/SEG3/TCK1
PD4/SEG4/TP1A
PD5/SEG5
/TP1B_0
Rev. 1.00
Function
OPT
I/T
PB5
PBPU
PBFS
O/T
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
TP1B_0
PBFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PB6
PBPU
PBFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
TP1B_1
PBFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PB7
PBPU
PBFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
TP1B_2
PBFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PC0
PCPU
PCFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
V2
PCFS
—
PC1
PCPU
PCFS
ST
C1
PCFS
—
PC2
PCPU
PCFS
ST
AO
Description
LCD voltage pump
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD voltage pump
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
C2
PCFS
—
PCn
PCPU
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD voltage pump
PD0
PDPU
PDFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
SEG0
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
INT1
INTEG
INTC0
SFS
ST
—
External Interrupt 1
PD1
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG1
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
TCK0
SFS
ST
—
TM0 input
PD2
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG2
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
TCK2
SFS
ST
—
TM2 input
PD3
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG3
PDFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
TCK1
SFS
ST
—
TM1 input
PD4
PDPU
PDFS
ST
SEG4
PDFS
SFS
—
TP1A
PDFS
SFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PD5
PDPU
PDFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
SEG5
PDFS
SFS
—
TP1B_0
PDFS
SFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
AO
LCD segment output
LCD segment output
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
21
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Pad Name
PD6/SEG6
/TP1B_1
PD7/SEG7
/TP1B_2
PE0/SEG8
PE1/SEG9
PE2/SEG10
PE3/SEG11
PE4/SEG12
PE5/SEG13
PE6/SEG14
PE7/SEG15
PF0/SEG16
PF1/SEG17
PF2/SEG18
PF3/SEG19
PF4/SEG20
Rev. 1.00
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Function
OPT
I/T
PD6
PDPU
PDFS
O/T
Description
ST
SEG6
PDFS
SFS
—
TP1B_1
PDFS
SFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PD7
PDPU
PDFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
SEG7
PDFS
SFS
—
TP1B_2
PDFS
SFS
ST
CMOS TM1 I/O pin
PE0
PEPU
PEFS
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
SEG8
PEFS
—
PE1
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG9
PEFS
—
PE2
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG10
PEFS
—
PE3
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG11
PEFS
—
PE4
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG12
PEFS
—
PE5
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG13
PEFS
—
PE6
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG14
PEFS
—
PE7
PEPU
PEFS
ST
SEG15
PEFS
—
PF0
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG16
PFFS
—
PF1
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG17
PFFS
—
PF2
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG18
PFFS
—
PF3
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG19
PFFS
—
PF4
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG20
PFFS
—
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
AO
AO
LCD segment output
LCD segment output
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
22
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Pad Name
PF5/SEG21
PF6/SEG22
PF7/SEG23
PG0/SEG24
PG1/SEG25
PG2/SEG26
PG3/SEG27
PG4/SEG28
PG5/SEG29
PG6/SEG30
PG7/SEG31
PH0/SEG32
PH1/SEG33
PH2/SEG34
PH3/SEG35
PH4/SEG36
PH5/SEG37
Rev. 1.00
Function
OPT
I/T
PF5
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG21
PFFS
—
PF6
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG22
PFFS
—
PF7
PFPU
PFFS
ST
SEG23
PFFS
—
PG0
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG24
PGFS
—
PG1
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG25
PGFS
—
PG2
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG26
PGFS
—
PG3
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG27
PGFS
—
PG4
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG28
PGFS
—
PG5
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG29
PGFS
—
PG6
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG30
PGFS
—
PG7
PGPU
PGFS
ST
SEG31
PGFS
—
PH0
PHPU
PHFS
ST
SEG32
PHFS
—
PH1
PHPU
PHFS
ST
SEG33
PHFS
—
PH2
PHPU
PHFS
ST
SEG34
PHFS
—
PH3
PHPU
PHFS
ST
SEG35
PHFS
—
PH4
PHPU
PHFS
ST
SEG36
PHFS
—
PH5
PHPU
PHFS
ST
SEG37
PHFS
—
O/T
Description
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
23
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Pad Name
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Function
OPT
I/T
PH6
PHPU
PHFS
ST
SEG38
PHFS
—
PH7
PHPU
PHFS
ST
SEG39
PHFS
—
AO
LCD segment output
SEG40~SEG47
SEGn
—
—
AO
LCD segment outputs
COM0~COM2
COMn
—
—
AO
LCD common outputs
COM3
—
—
AO
LCD common output
SEG48
LCDC
—
AO
LCD segment output
V1
—
—
AO
LCD voltage pump
VLCD
VLCD
—
PWR
—
LCD power supply
VMAX
VMAX
—
PWR
—
IC maximum voltage, connected to VDD, VLCD or V1
VDD
VDD
—
PWR
—
Positive Power supply
VSS
VSS
—
PWR
—
Negative Power supply. Ground
PH6/SEG38
PH7/SEG39
COM3/SEG48
V1
O/T
Description
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
AO
LCD segment output
CMOS General purpose I/O. Register enabled pull-up
Note: I/T: Input type;
O/T: Output type
OPT: Optional by configuration option (CO) or register option
PWR: Power;
CO: Configuration option
ST: Schmitt Trigger input;
AO: Analog output
CMOS: CMOS output;
NMOS: NMOS output
HXT: High frequency crystal oscillator
LXT: High frequency crystal oscillator
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Supply Voltage .................................................................................................VSS-0.3V to VSS+6.0V
Input Voltage ...................................................................................................VSS-0.3V to VDD+0.3V
IOL Total ....................................................................................................80mA
Total Power Dissipation ......................................................................................................... 500mW
Storage Temperature .................................................................................................. -50°C to 125°C
Operating Temperature . ............................................................................................... -40°C to 85°C
IOH Total...................................................................................................-80mA
Note: These are stress ratings only. Stresses exceeding the range specified under “Absolute
Maximum Ratings” may cause substantial damage to the device. Functional operation of
this device at other conditions beyond those listed in the specification is not implied and
prolonged exposure to extreme conditions may affect device reliability.
Rev. 1.00
24
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
D.C. Characteristics
Ta=25°C
Symbol
VDD1
VDD2
VDD3
Parameter
Operating Voltage (HXT)
Operating Voltage (ERC)
Operating Voltage (HIRC)
Test Conditions
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
fSYS=4MHz
2.2
—
5.5
V
fSYS=8MHz
2.2
—
5.5
V
fSYS=12MHz
2.7
—
5.5
V
fSYS=16MHz
4.5
—
5.5
V
fSYS=4MHz
2.2
—
5.5
V
fSYS=8MHz
2.4
—
5.5
V
fSYS=12MHz
2.7
—
5.5
V
fSYS=16MHz
4.5
—
5.5
V
fSYS=20MHz
4.5
—
5.5
V
fSYS=4MHz
2.2
—
5.5
V
fSYS=8MHz
2.2
—
5.5
V
fSYS=12MHz
2.7
—
5.5
V
—
100
150
μA
—
280
450
μA
—
250
400
μA
—
500
1000
μA
—
450
700
μA
—
1000
1500
μA
—
0.8
1.5
mA
—
1.5
3.0
mA
—
1.5
2.5
mA
—
3.0
5.0
mA
5V No load, fH=16MHz, WDT enable
—
4.0
6.0
mA
3V
—
66
110
μA
—
200
300
μA
—
250
400
μA
—
500
1000
μA
—
450
700
μA
—
1000
1500
μA
—
0.8
1.5
mA
—
1.5
3.0
mA
—
1.5
2.5
mA
—
3.0
5.0
mA
5V No load, fH=16MHz, WDT enable
—
4.0
6.0
mA
3V
—
420
630
μA
—
700
1000
μA
—
0.8
1.5
mA
—
1.5
3.0
mA
—
1.5
2.5
mA
—
3.0
5.0
mA
—
330
500
μA
—
550
820
μA
VDD
—
—
—
3V
5V
3V
5V
IDD1
Operating Current
(HXT, fSYS=fH,
fS=fSUB=fRTC or fLIRC)
3V
5V
3V
5V
3V
5V
5V
3V
5V
IDD2
Operating Current
(ERC, fSYS=fH,
fS=fSUB=fRTC or fLIRC)
3V
5V
3V
5V
3V
5V
IDD3
Operating Current
(HIRC OSC, fSYS=fH,
fS=fSUB=fRTC or fLIRC)
5V
3V
5V
3V
5V
IDD4
Rev. 1.00
Operating Current
(EC, fSYS=fH,
fS=fSUB=fRTC or fLIRC)
3V
5V
Conditions
No load, fH=455kHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=1MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=4MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=8MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=12MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=455kHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=1MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=4MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=8MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=12MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=4MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=8MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=12MHz, WDT enable
No load, fH=4MHz, WDT enable
25
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Symbol
Parameter
Test Conditions
Max.
Unit
500
750
μA
800
1200
μA
—
420
630
μA
—
700
1000
μA
—
400
600
μA
—
600
800
μA
—
360
540
μA
—
560
700
μA
—
320
480
μA
—
520
650
μA
—
280
420
μA
—
440
600
μA
3V No load, fH=4MHz, fL=fH/2, WDT enable
—
270
400
μA
5V No load, fH=4MHz, fL=fH/2, WDT enable
—
560
840
μA
3V No load, fH=4MHz, fL=fH/4, WDT enable
—
180
270
μA
5V No load, fH=4MHz, fL=fH/4, WDT enable
—
400
600
μA
3V No load, fH=12MHz, fL=fH/2, WDT enable
—
0.9
1.5
mA
5V No load, fH=12MHz, fL=fH/2, WDT enable
—
1.8
2.7
mA
3V No load, fH=12MHz, fL=fH/4, WDT enable
—
0.6
1.0
mA
5V No load, fH=12MHz, fL=fH/4, WDT enable
—
0.9
1.4
mA
3V
—
10
20
μA
—
20
35
μA
—
10
20
μA
—
20
35
μA
—
10
20
μA
—
30
50
μA
—
10
20
μA
—
30
50
μA
—
10
20
μA
—
20
35
μA
—
10
20
μA
—
30
50
μA
—
10
20
μA
—
20
35
μA
—
10
20
μA
VDD
3V
5V
3V
5V
IDD5
Operating Current
(HXT, fSYS=fL,
fS=fSUB=fRTC or fLIRC)
3V
5V
3V
5V
3V
5V
3V
5V
IDD6
IDD7
IDD8
IDD8a
Operating Current
(HXT, fSYS=fL,
fS=fSUB=fRTC or fLIRC)
Operating Current
(HXT, fSYS=fL,
fS=fSUB=fRTC or fLIRC)
Operating Current
(LXT, fSYS=fL=fRTC,
fS=fSUB=fRTC)
(HT69F30A, HT69F40A)
Operating Current
(LXT, fSYS=fL=fRTC,
fS=fSUB=fRTC)
(HT69F50A)
5V
3V
5V
3V
5V
3V
5V
Operating Current
(LIRC, fSYS=fL=fLIRC,
fS=fSUB=fLIRC)
(HT69F30A, HT69F40A)
3V
IDD9a
Operating Current
(LIRC, fSYS=fL=fLIRC,
fS=fSUB=fLIRC) (HT69F50A)
3V
IDD10
Operating Current
(LXT or LIRC, fSYS=fL=fSUB)
(HT69F30A, HT69F40A)
3V
IDD10a
Operating Current
(LXT or LIRC, fSYS=fL=fSUB)
(HT69F50A)
3V
ISTB1
Standby Current (Idle1)
(HXT, fSYS=fH, fS=fSUB=fRTC or
fLIRC)
3V
ISTB2
Standby Current (Idle0)
(HXT, fSYS=off,
fS=fSUB=fRTC or fLIRC)
ISTB3
Standby Current (Idle0)
(HIRC, fSYS=off, fS=fSUB=fLIRC)
IDD9
Rev. 1.00
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Conditions
No load, fH=8MHz, fL=fH/2, WDT enable
No load, fH=8MHz, fL=fH/4, WDT enable
No load, fH=8MHz, fL=fH/8, WDT enable
No load, fH=8MHz, fL=fH/16, WDT enable
No load, fH=8MHz, fL=fH/32, WDT enable
No load, fH=8MHz, fL=fH/64, WDT enable
No load, WDT enable, QOSC=0
No load, WDT enable, QOSC=1
No load, WDT enable, QOSC=0
No load, WDT enable, QOSC=1
Min.
Typ.
—
—
No load, WDT enable
5V
5V
5V
5V
No load, WDT enable
No load, WDT enable, QOSC=0
No load, WDT enable, QOSC=0
—
30
50
μA
—
0.3
0.5
μA
—
0.5
0.8
μA
3V No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=8MHz, LXTLP=1
—
1.5
3.0
μA
—
2.5
5.0
μA
3V No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=8MHz
—
1.5
3.0
μA
—
2.5
5.0
μA
No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=8MHz, FSYSON=1
26
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Symbol
Parameter
Test Conditions
VDD
Conditions
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
Standby Current (Idle0.)
(HIRC, fSYS=off, fS=fSUB=fLIRC)
3V No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=32768Hz, LXTLP=1
—
1.5
3.0
μA
—
2.5
5.0
μA
Standby Current (Idle0)
(LXT, fSYS=off)
3V No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=32768Hz
—
1.5
3.0
μA
—
2.5
5.0
μA
ISTB6
Standby Current (Idle0)
(fSYS=fL=fRTC, fS=fSUB=fRTC)
3V No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=32768Hz, LXTLP=1
—
1.9
4.0
μA
—
3.3
7.0
μA
ISTB7
Standby Current (Idle)
(LIRC, fSYS=off, fS=fSUB=fLIRC)
3V No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=32kHz
—
1.5
3.0
μA
—
2.5
5.0
μA
ISTB8
Standby Current (Sleep0)
(HXT, fSYS=off,
fS=fSUB=fRTC or fLIRC)
3V No load, system HALT, WDT disable,
5V fSYS=12MHz, LXTLP=1
—
0.1
1
μA
—
0.3
2
μA
ISTB9
Standby Current (Sleep1)
(HXT, fSYS=off, fS=fSUB=fRTC)
3V No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=12MHz
—
1.5
3.0
μA
—
2.5
5.0
μA
ISTB10
Standby Current (Sleep1)
(HXT, fSYS=off, fS=fSUB=fLIRC)
3V No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=12MHz
—
1.5
3.0
μA
—
2.5
5.0
μA
ISTB11
Standby Current (Sleep0)
(LXT, fSYS=off, fS=fSUB=fRTC)
3V No load, system HALT, WDT disable,
5V fSYS=32768Hz
—
0.1
1
μA
—
0.3
2
μA
ISTB12
Standby Current (Sleep1)
(LXT, fSYS=off, fS=fSUB=fRTC)
3V No load, system HALT, WDT enable,
5V fSYS=32768Hz, LXTLP=1
—
1.5
3.0
μA
—
2.5
5.0
μA
VIL1
Input Low Voltage for PA,
PB, PC, PD, PE, PF, TCKn
and INTn
0V
—
1.5V
V
0V
—
0.2VDD
V
VIH1
Input High Voltage for PA,
PB, PC, PD, PE, PF, TCKn
and INTn
3.5V
—
5V
V
—
0.8VDD
—
VDD
V
VIL2
Input Low Voltage (RES)
—
—
0
—
0.4VDD
V
VIH2
Input High Voltage (RES)
—
—
0.9VDD
—
VDD
V
3V VOL=0.1VDD
4
8
—
mA
5V VOL=0.1VDD
10
20
—
mA
3V VOH=0.9VDD
-2
-4
—
mA
5V VOH=0.9VDD
-5
-10
—
mA
ISTB4
ISTB5
IOL
IOH
RPH
Rev. 1.00
I/O Port Sink Current
I/O Port Source Current
Pull-high Resistance of I/O
Ports
5
—
—
5
—
3V
—
20
60
100
kΩ
5V
—
10
30
50
kΩ
27
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
A.C. Characteristics
Ta=25°C
Symbol
fCPU
fSYS
Parameter
Operating Clock
System clock (HXT)
Test Conditions
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
2.2~5.5V
DC
—
4
MHz
2.4~5.5V
DC
—
8
MHz
2.7~5.5V
DC
—
12
MHz
4.5~5.5V
DC
—
16
MHz
2.2V~5.5V
0.4
—
4
MHz
2.2V~5.5V
0.4
—
8
MHz
0.4
—
12
MHz
VDD
—
Condition
—
2.7V~5.5V
4.5V~5.5V
fHIRC
fERC
System clock (HIRC)
System clock (ERC)
0.4
—
16
MHz
3V/5V
Ta=25°C
-2%
4
+2%
MHz
3V/5V
Ta=25°C
-2%
8
+2%
MHz
5V
Ta=25°C
-2%
12
+2%
MHz
2.2V~3.6V Ta=-40°C~85°C
-8%
4
+8%
MHz
3.0V~5.5V Ta=-40°C~85°C
-8%
4
+8%
MHz
2.2V~3.6V Ta=-40°C~85°C
-8%
8
+8%
MHz
3.0V~5.5V Ta=-40°C~85°C
-8%
8
+8%
MHz
3.0V~5.5V Ta=-40°C~85°C
-8%
12
+8%
MHz
5V
Ta=25°C
External RERC=150kΩ
-2%
4
+2%
MHz
5V
Ta=0°C~70°C
External RERC=150kΩ
-5%
4
+5%
MHz
5V
Ta=-40°C~85°C
External RERC=150kΩ
-7%
4
+7%
MHz
3.0V~5.5V
Ta=-40°C~85°C
External RERC=150kΩ
-9%
4
+9%
MHz
2.2V~5.5V
Ta=-40°C~85°C
External RERC=150kΩ
-12%
4
+12%
MHz
—
—
—
32768
—
Hz
-10%
32
+10%
kHz
-50%
32
+60%
kHz
fLXT
System Clock (LXT)
fLIRC
System Clock (LIRC)
tTIMER
TCKn and timer capture Input Pulse
Width
—
—
0.3
—
—
μs
tRES
External Reset Low Pulse Width
—
—
10
—
—
μs
tINT
Interrupt Pulse Width
—
—
10
—
—
μs
1024
—
—
tSYS
—
fSYS=HXT or LXT
(Slow Mode→Normal
Mode(HXT),
Normal Mode→Slow
Mode(LXT))
fSYS=HXT or LXT
(Wake-up from HALT,
fSYS off at HALT state)
1024
─
─
tSYS
tSST
System Start-up Timer Period
(Wake-up from HALT, fSYS off at HALT
state, Slow Mode→Normal Mode,
Normal Mode→Slow Mode)
System Start-up Timer Period
(Wake-up from HALT,
fSYS on at HALT state)
Rev. 1.00
5V
Ta=25°C
2.2V~5.5V Ta=-40°C~85°C
—
fSYS=ERC or HIRC
16
—
—
tSYS
—
fSYS=LIRC or EC
2
—
—
tSYS
2
—
—
tSYS
—
—
28
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Symbol
Test Conditions
Parameter
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
—
25
50
100
ms
—
—
8.3
16.7
33.3
ms
VBG turn on stable time
—
—
10
—
—
ms
EEPROM Read Time
—
—
1
2
4
tSYS
EEPROM Write Timet
—
—
1
2
4
ms
VDD
Condition
System Reset Delay Time
(Power On Reset, LVR reset,
LVR S/W reset (LVRC),
WDT S/W reset (WDTC))
—
System Reset Delay Time
(RES reset, WDT normal reset)
tBGS
tEERD
tEEWR
tRSTD
Note: tSYS=1/fSYS
LVD & LVR Electrical Characteristics
Ta=25°C
Symbol
Parameter
Test Conditions
VDD
Conditions
Min.
Typ. Max. Unit
VLVR1
LVR Enable, 2.1V option
2.1
VLVR2
LVR Enable, 2.55V option
2.55
VLVR3
Low Voltage Reset Voltage
—
LVR Enable, 3.15V option
-5%
3.15
+5%
V
VLVR4
LVR Enable, 3.8V option
3.8
VLVD1
LVDEN=1, VLVD=2.0V
2.0
V
VLVD2
LVDEN=1, VLVD=2.2V
2.2
V
VLVD3
LVDEN=1, VLVD=2.4V
2.4
V
VLVD4
LVDEN=1, VLVD=2.7V
2.7
VLVD5
Low Voltage Detector Voltage
—
LVDEN=1, VLVD=3.0V
-5%
3.0
+5%
V
V
VLVD6
LVDEN=1, VLVD=3.3V
3.3
V
VLVD7
LVDEN=1, VLVD=3.6V
3.6
V
LVDEN=1, VLVD=4.0V
4.0
V
VLVD8
VBG
Bandgap reference with buffer
voltage
—
—
-3%
1.25
+3%
V
IBG
Additional Power Consumption
if bandgap reference with
—
buffer is used
—
—
200
300
μA
ILVR
Additional Power Consumption 3V
LVR disable→LVR enable
if LVR is used
5V
—
10
20
μA
—
15
30
μA
—
10
20
μA
ILVD
3V LVD disable→LVD enable
Additional Power Consumption 5V (LVR disable)
if LVD is used
3V LVD disable→LVD enable
5V (LVR enable)
—
15
30
μA
—
1
2
μA
—
2
4
μA
tLVR
Low Voltage Width to Reset
—
—
120
240
480
μs
tLVD
Low Voltage Width to Interrupt
—
—
20
45
90
tLIRC
tLVDS
LVDO stable time
— For LVR enable, LVD off→on
15
—
—
μs
— For LVR disable, LVD off→on
15
—
—
μs
tSRESET
Software Reset Width to Reset —
20
45
90
tLIRC
Rev. 1.00
—
29
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
LCD D.C. Characteristics
Ta=25°C
Symbol
Parameter
Test Condition
Typ.
Max.
Unit
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, C type, VLCD=VDD, 1/2 Bias,
—
2.0
4.0
μA
—
3.0
5.0
μA
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, C type, VLCD=VDD, 1/3 Bias,
—
2.0
4.0
μA
—
3.0
5.0
μA
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, R type, VLCD=VDD, 1/2 bias
(IBIAS=7.5μA)
—
13.5
20.0
μA
—
22.5
40.0
μA
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, R type, VLCD=VDD, 1/2 bias
(IBIAS=15μA)
—
21
40
μA
—
35
60
μA
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, R type, VLCD=VDD, 1/2 bias
(IBIAS=45μA)
—
51
80
μA
—
85
160
μA
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, R type, VLCD=VDD, 1/2 bias
(IBIAS=90μA)
—
96
160
μA
—
160
320
μA
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, R type, VLCD=VDD, 1/3 bias
(IBIAS=7.5μA)
—
11
20
μA
—
18.3
40
μA
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, R type, VLCD=VDD, 1/3 bias
(IBIAS=15μA)
—
16
25
μA
—
26.6
50
μA
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, R type, VLCD=VDD, 1/3 bias
(IBIAS=45μA)
—
36
50
μA
—
60
100
μA
No load, system HALT, LCD on,
WDT off, R type, VLCD=VDD, 1/3 bias
(IBIAS=90μA)
—
66
100
μA
—
110
200
μA
210
420
—
μA
350
700
—
μA
-80
-160
—
μA
-180
-360
—
μA
Condition
ISTB1
Standby Current (Sleep)
(fSYS, fWDT off,
fS=fSUB=32768 or 32K RC OSC)
3V
ISTB2
Standby Current (Sleep)
(fSYS, fWDT off,
fS=fSUB=32768 or 32K RC OSC)
3V
ISTB3
Standby Current (Idle)
(fSYS, fWDT off,
fS=fSUB=32768 or 32K RC OSC)
3V
ISTB4
Standby Current (Idle)
(fSYS, fWDT off,
fS=fSUB=32768 or 32K RC OSC)
3V
ISTB5
Standby Current (Idle)
(fSYS, fWDT off, fS=fSUB=32768 or
32K RC OSC)
3V
ISTB6
Standby Current (Idle)
(fSYS, fWDT off,
fS=fSUB=32768 or 32K RC OSC)
3V
ISTB7
Standby Current (Idle)
(fSYS, fWDT off,
fS=fSUB=32768 or 32K RC OSC)
3V
ISTB8
Standby Current (Idle)
(fSYS, fWDT off,
fS=fSUB=32768 or 32K RC OSC)
3V
ISTB9
Standby Current (Idle)
(fSYS, fWDT off,
fS=fSUB=32768 or 32K RC OSC)
3V
ISTB10
Standby Current (Idle)
(fSYS, fWDT off,
fS=fSUB=32768 or 32K RC OSC)
3V
IOL2
LCD Common and Segment
Sink Current
3V
IOH2
LCD Common and Segment
Source Current
3V
Rev. 1.00
Min.
VDD
5V
5V
5V
5V
5V
5V
5V
5V
5V
5V
5V
5V
VOL=0.1VLCD
VOH=0.9VLCD
30
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Power-on Reset Characteristics
Ta=25°C
Symbol
Test Conditions
Parameter
VDD
Conditions
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
VPOR
VDD Start Voltage to Ensure Power-on Reset
—
—
—
—
100
mV
RRVDD
VDD Raising Rate to Ensure Power-on Reset
—
—
0.035
—
—
V/ms
tPOR
Minimum Time for VDD Stays at VPOR to Ensure
Power-on Reset
—
—
1
—
—
ms
System Architecture
A key factor in the high-performance features of the Holtek range of microcontrollers is attributed
to their internal system architecture. The range of devices take advantage of the usual features found
within RISC microcontrollers providing increased speed of operation and enhanced performance.
The pipelining scheme is implemented in such a way that instruction fetching and instruction
execution are overlapped, hence instructions are effectively executed in one cycle, with the
exception of branch or call instructions. An 8-bit wide ALU is used in practically all instruction set
operations, which carries out arithmetic operations, logic operations, rotation, increment, decrement,
branch decisions, etc. The internal data path is simplified by moving data through the Accumulator
and the ALU. Certain internal registers are implemented in the Data Memory and can be directly
or indirectly addressed. The simple addressing methods of these registers along with additional
architectural features ensure that a minimum of external components is required to provide a
functional I/O control system with maximum reliability and flexibility. This makes the device
suitable for low-cost, high-volume production for controller applications.
Clocking and Pipelining
The main system clock, derived from either a HXT, LXT, HIRC, LIRC, EC or ERC oscillator is
subdivided into four internally generated non-overlapping clocks, T1~T4. The Program Counter is
incremented at the beginning of the T1 clock during which time a new instruction is fetched. The
remaining T2~T4 clocks carry out the decoding and execution functions. In this way, one T1~T4
clock cycle forms one instruction cycle. Although the fetching and execution of instructions takes
place in consecutive instruction cycles, the pipelining structure of the microcontroller ensures that
instructions are effectively executed in one instruction cycle. The exception to this are instructions
where the contents of the Program Counter are changed, such as subroutine calls or jumps, in which
case the instruction will take one more instruction cycle to execute.
For instructions involving branches, such as jump or call instructions, two machine cycles are
required to complete instruction execution. An extra cycle is required as the program takes one
cycle to first obtain the actual jump or call address and then another cycle to actually execute the
branch. The requirement for this extra cycle should be taken into account by programmers in timing
sensitive applications.
Rev. 1.00
31
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM


   
   
System Clocking and Pipelining
  
    
 Instruction Fetching
Program Counter
During program execution, the Program Counter is used to keep track of the address of the
next instruction to be executed. It is automatically incremented by one each time an instruction
is executed except for instructions, such as “JMP” or “CALL” that demand a jump to a
non-consecutive Program Memory address. Only the lower 8 bits, known as the Program Counter
Low Register, are directly addressable by the application program.
When executing instructions requiring jumps to non-consecutive addresses such as a jump instruction,
a subroutine call, interrupt or reset, etc., the microcontroller manages program control by loading
the required address into the Program Counter. For conditional skip instructions, once the condition
has been met, the next instruction, which has already been fetched during the present instruction
execution, is discarded and a dummy cycle takes its place while the correct instruction is obtained.
Device
HT69F30A
Program Counter
Porgram Counter High Byte
Porgram Counter Low Byte
PC10~PC8
HT69F40A
PC11~PC8
HT69F50A
PC12~PC8
PCL7~PCL0
Program Counter
The lower byte of the Program Counter, known as the Program Counter Low register or PCL, is
available for program control and is a readable and writeable register. By transferring data directly
into this register, a short program jump can be executed directly, however, as only this low byte is
available for manipulation, the jumps are limited to the present page of memory, that is 256 locations.
When such program jumps are executed it should also be noted that a dummy cycle will be inserted.
Manipulating the PCL register may cause program branching, so an extra cycle is needed to pre-fetch.
Rev. 1.00
32
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Stack
This is a special part of the memory which is used to save the contents of the Program Counter only.
The stack has multiple levels depending upon the device and is neither part of the data nor part of
the program space, and is neither readable nor writeable. The activated level is indexed by the Stack
Pointer, and is neither readable nor writeable. At a subroutine call or interrupt acknowledge signal, the
contents of the Program Counter are pushed onto the stack. At the end of a subroutine or an interrupt
routine, signaled by a return instruction, RET or RETI, the Program Counter is restored to its previous
value from the stack. After a device reset, the Stack Pointer will point to the top of the stack.
If the stack is full and an enabled interrupt takes place, the interrupt request flag will be recorded but
the acknowledge signal will be inhibited. When the Stack Pointer is decremented, by RET or RETI,
the interrupt will be serviced. This feature prevents stack overflow allowing the programmer to use
the structure more easily. However, when the stack is full, a CALL subroutine instruction can still
be executed which will result in a stack overflow. Precautions should be taken to avoid such cases
which might cause unpredictable program branching.
If the stack is overflow, the first Program Counter save in the stack will be lost.
P ro g ra m
T o p o f S ta c k
S ta c k L e v e l 1
S ta c k L e v e l 2
S ta c k
P o in te r
B o tto m
C o u n te r
P ro g ra m
M e m o ry
S ta c k L e v e l 3
o f S ta c k
S ta c k L e v e l N
Device
Stack Levels
HT69F30A
4
HT69F40A
8
HT69F50A
8
Arithmetic and Logic Unit – ALU
The arithmetic-logic unit or ALU is a critical area of the microcontroller that carries out arithmetic
and logic operations of the instruction set. Connected to the main microcontroller data bus, the ALU
receives related instruction codes and performs the required arithmetic or logical operations after
which the result will be placed in the specified register. As these ALU calculation or operations may
result in carry, borrow or other status changes, the status register will be correspondingly updated to
reflect these changes. The ALU supports the following functions:
• Arithmetic operations: ADD, ADDM, ADC, ADCM, SUB, SUBM, SBC, SBCM, DAA
• Logic operations: AND, OR, XOR, ANDM, ORM, XORM, CPL, CPLA
• Rotation RRA, RR, RRCA, RRC, RLA, RL, RLCA, RLC
• Increment and Decrement INCA, INC, DECA, DEC
• Branch decision, JMP, SZ, SZA, SNZ, SIZ, SDZ, SIZA, SDZA, CALL, RET, RETI
Rev. 1.00
33
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Flash Program Memory
The Program Memory is the location where the user code or program is stored. For this device
series the Program Memory is Flash type, which means it can be programmed and re-programmed
a large number of times, allowing the user the convenience of code modification on the same
device. By using the appropriate programming tools, these Flash devices offer users the flexibility to
conveniently debug and develop their applications while also offering a means of field programming
and updating.
Structure
The Program Memory has a capacity of up to 8k×16 bits. The Program Memory is addressed by the
Program Counter and also contains data, table information and interrupt entries information. Table
data, which can be setup in any location within the Program Memory, is addressed by separate table
pointer registers.
0000H
0004H
001CH
07FFH
Device
Capacity
HT69F30A
2K×16
HT69F40A
4K×16
HT69F50A
8K×16
HT69F30A
HT69F40A
HT69F50A
Reset
Reset
Reset
Interrupt
Vector
Interrupt
Vector
Interrupt
Vector
16 bits
0FFFH
16 bits
1FFFH
16 bits
Program Memory Structure
Rev. 1.00
34
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Special Vectors
Within the Program Memory, certain locations are reserved for the reset and interrupts. The location
000H is reserved for use by the device reset for program initialisation. After a device reset is
initiated, the program will jump to this location and begin execution.
Look-up Table
Any location within the Program Memory can be defined as a look-up table where programmers can
store fixed data. To use the look-up table, the table pointer must first be setup by placing the address
of the look up data to be retrieved in the table pointer register, TBLP and TBHP. These registers
define the total address of the look-up table.
After setting up the table pointer, the table data can be retrieved from the Program Memory
using the “TABRDC [m]” or “TABRDL [m]” instructions, respectively. When the instruction is
executed, the lower order table byte from the Program Memory will be transferred to the user
defined Data Memory register [m] as specified in the instruction. The higher order table data byte
from the Program Memory will be transferred to the TBLH special register. Any unused bits in this
transferred higher order byte will be read as 0.
The accompanying diagram illustrates the addressing data flow of the look-up table.
A d d re s s
L a s t p a g e o r
T B H P R e g is te r
T B L P R e g is te r
D a ta
1 6 b its
R e g is te r T B L H
U s e r S e le c te d
R e g is te r
H ig h B y te
L o w B y te
Table Program Example
The accompanying example shows how the table pointer and table data is defined and retrieved from
the device. This example uses raw table data located in the last page which is stored there using the
ORG statement. The value at this ORG statement is “700H” which refers to the start address of the
last page within the 2K Program Memory of the HT69F30A device. The table pointer is setup here
to have an initial value of “06H”. This will ensure that the first data read from the data table will be
at the Program Memory address “706H” or 6 locations after the start of the last page. Note that the
value for the table pointer is referenced to the first address of the present page if the “TABRDC [m]”
instruction is being used. The high byte of the table data which in this case is equal to zero will be
transferred to the TBLH register automatically when the “TABRDC [m]” instruction is executed.
Because the TBLH register is a read-only register and cannot be restored, care should be taken
to ensure its protection if both the main routine and Interrupt Service Routine use table read
instructions. If using the table read instructions, the Interrupt Service Routines may change the
value of the TBLH and subsequently cause errors if used again by the main routine. As a rule it is
recommended that simultaneous use of the table read instructions should be avoided. However, in
situations where simultaneous use cannot be avoided, the interrupts should be disabled prior to the
execution of any main routine table-read instructions. Note that all table related instructions require
two instruction cycles to complete their operation.
Rev. 1.00
35
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Table Read Program Example
tempreg1 db ?; temporary register #1
tempreg2 db ?; temporary register #2
:
:
mov a,06h ; initialise table pointer - note that this address
; is referenced to the last page or present page
mov tblp, a
:
:
tabrdl tempreg1 ; transfers value in table referenced by table pointer
; to tempreg1
; data at program memory address “706H” transferred to
; to tempreg1 and TBLH
dec tblp ; reduce value of table pointer by one
tabrdl tempreg2 ; transfers value in table referenced by table pointer
; to tempreg2
; data at program memory address “705H” transferred to
; tempreg2 and TBLH
; in this example the data “1AH” is transferred to
; tempreg1 and data “0FH” to register tempreg2
; the value “00H” will be transferred to the high byte
; register TBLH
:
:
org 700h; sets initial address of last page
dc 00Ah, 00Bh, 00Ch, 00Dh, 00Eh, 00Fh, 01Ah, 01Bh
:
:
In Circuit Programming – ICP
The provision of Flash type Program Memory provides the user with a means of convenient and
easy upgrades and modifications to their programs on the same device.
As an additional convenience, Holtek has provided a means of programming the microcontroller
in-circuit using a 4-pin interface. This provides manufacturers with the possibility of manufacturing
their circuit boards complete with a programmed or un-programmed microcontroller, and then
programming or upgrading the program at a later stage. This enables product manufacturers to easily
keep their manufactured products supplied with the latest program releases without removal and
re-insertion of the device.
Holtek Writer Pins
MCU Programming Pins
Pin Description
ICPDA
PA0
Programming Serial Data
ICPCK
PA2
Programming Clock
VDD
VDD
Power Supply
VSS
VSS
Ground
The Program Memory can be programmed serially in-circuit using this 4-wire interface. Data
is downloaded and uploaded serially on a single pin with an additional line for the clock. Two
additional lines are required for the power supply and one line for the reset. The technical details
regarding the in-circuit programming of the devices are beyond the scope of this document and will
be supplied in supplementary literature.
Rev. 1.00
36
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
During the programming process, taking control of the ICPDA and ICPCK pins for data and clock
programming purposes. The user must there take care to ensure that no other outputs are connected
to these two pins.
W r ite r C o n n e c to r
S ig n a ls
M C U
P r o g r a m m in g
P in s
W r ite r _ V D D
V D D
IC P D A
P A 0
IC P C K
P A 2
W r ite r _ V S S
V S S
*
*
T o o th e r C ir c u it
Note: * may be resistor or capacitor. The resistance of * must be greater
than 1k or the capacitance of * must be less than 1nF.
On-Chip Debug Support – OCDS
There is an EV chip named HT69V0A which is used to emulate the HT69Fx0A series of devices.
The HT69V50A device also provides the “On-Chip Debug” function to debug the HT69Fx0A
series of devices during development process. The devices, HT69Fx0A and HT69V50A, are almost
functional compatible except the “On-Chip Debug” function and package types. Users can use
the HT69V50A device to emulate the HT69Fx0A series of devices behaviors by connecting the
OCDSDA and OCDSCK pins to the Holtek HT-IDE development tools. The OCDSDA pin is the
OCDS Data/Address input/output pin while the OCDSCK pin is the OCDS clock input pin. When
users use the HT69V50A EV chip for debugging, the corresponding pin functions shared with
the OCDSDA and OCDSCK pins in the HT69Fx0A series of devices will have no effect in the
HT69V50A EV chip. However, the two OCDS pins which are pin-shared with the ICP programming
pins are still used as the Flash Memory programming pins for ICP. For more detailed OCDS
information, refer to the corresponding document named “Holtek e-Link for 8-bit MCU OCDS
User’s Guide”.
Rev. 1.00
Holtek e-Link Pins
EV Chip Pins
OCDSDA
OCDSDA
On-Chip Debug Support Data/Address input/output
Pin Description
OCDSCK
OCDSCK
On-Chip Debug Support Clock input
VDD
VDD
Power Supply
GND
VSS
Ground
37
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Data Memory
The Data Memory is an 8-bit wide RAM internal memory and is the location where temporary
information is stored.
Divided into three sections, the first of these is an area of RAM where special function registers are
located. These registers have fixed locations and are necessary for correct operation of the device.
Many of these registers can be read from and written to directly under program control, however,
some remain protected from user manipulation. The second area of Data Memory is reserved for
general purpose use. All locations within this area are read and write accessible under program
control. The third area is reserved for the LCD Memory. This special area of Data Memory is
mapped directly to the LCD display so data written into this memory area will directly affect the
displayed data. Switching between the different Data Memory banks is achieved by setting the Bank
Pointer to the correct value.
Structure
The Data Memory is subdivided into several banks, all of which are implemented in 8-bit wide
RAM. The Data Memory located in Bank 0 is subdivided into two sections, the Special Purpose
Data Memory and the General Purpose Data Memory.
The start address of the Data Memory for all devices is the address 00H. Registers which are
common to all microcontrollers, such as ACC, PCL, etc., have the same Data Memory address. The
LCD Memory is mapped into Bank 1. The Banks 2 to 3 contain only General Purpose Data Memory
for those devices with larger Data Memory capacities. As the Special Purpose Data Memory
registers are mapped into all bank areas, they can subsequently be accessed from any bank location.
Device
Rev. 1.00
Capacity
Banks
HT69F30A
General Purpose: 128×8
LCD Memory: 25
0: 80H~FFH
1: 80H~98H
HT69F40A
General Purpose: 256×8
LCD Memory: 37
0: 80H~FFH
1: 80H~A4H
2: 80H~FFH
HT69F50A
General Purpose: 384×8
LCD Memory: 49
0: 80H~FFH
1: 80H~B0H
2: 80H~FFH
3: 80H~FFH
38
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Bank 0
00H
Special Purpose
Data Memory
40H in Bank 1
LCD Memory
in Bank 1
7FH
80H
General Purpose
Data Memory
Bank 0
FFH
Bank 2
Bank 3
Data Memory Structure
General Purpose Data Memory
All microcontroller programs require an area of read/write memory where temporary data can be
stored and retrieved for use later. It is this area of RAM memory that is known as General Purpose
Data Memory. This area of Data Memory is fully accessible by the user programing for both reading
and writing operations. By using the “SET [m].i” and “CLR [m].i” instructions individual bits can
be set or reset under program control giving the user a large range of flexibility for bit manipulation
in the Data Memory.
Special Purpose Data Memory
This area of Data Memory is where registers, necessary for the correct operation of the
microcontroller, are stored. Most of the registers are both readable and writeable but some are
protected and are readable only, the details of which are located under the relevant Special Function
Register section. Note that for locations that are unused, any read instruction to these addresses will
return the value “00H”.
Rev. 1.00
39
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Bank 0
Bank 0, 1
00H
01H
02H
03H
04H
IAR0
MP0
IAR1
MP1
BP
05H
06H
07H
08H
09H
0AH
0BH
0CH
0DH
0EH
0FH
10H
11H
12H
13H
14H
ACC
PCL
TBLP
TBLH
TBHP
STATUS
SMOD
LVDC
INTEG
WDTC
TBC
INTC0
INTC1
SMOD1
LVRC
15H
16H
17H
18H
19H
1AH
1BH
1CH
1DH
1EH
1FH
20H
21H
22H
23H
24H
25H
26H
27H
28H
29H
2AH
2BH
2CH
2DH
2EH
2FH
30H
31H
32H
33H
34H
35H
36H
37H
38H
39H
3AH
3BH
3CH
3DH
3EH
3FH
MFI0
MFI1
MFI2
Unused
PAWU
PAPU
PA
PAC
PBPU
PB
PBC
PCPU
PC
PCC
PDPU
PD
PDC
PEPU
PE
PEC
PFPU
PF
PFC
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Bank 1
40H
41H
42H
43H
EEC
EEA
EED
Unused
47H
48H
49H
4AH
4BH
4CH
4DH
TM1C0
TM1C1
TM1DL
TM1DH
TM1AL
TM1AH
4EH
Unused
5FH
60H
61H
LCDC
Unused
7FH
: Unused, read as 00H
PAFS
Unused
PCFS
PDFS
PEFS
PFFS
Unused
Unused
SFS
TM0C0
TM0C1
TM0DL
TM0DH
TM0AL
TM0AH
HT69F30A
Special Purpose Data Memory
HT69F30A Special Purpose Data Memory
Rev. 1.00
40
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Bank 0, 2
Bank 0, 1, 2
00H
01H
02H
03H
04H
05H
06H
07H
08H
09H
0AH
0BH
0CH
0DH
0EH
0FH
10H
11H
12H
13H
14H
15H
16H
17H
18H
19H
1AH
1BH
1CH
1DH
1EH
1FH
20H
21H
22H
23H
24H
25H
26H
27H
28H
29H
2AH
2BH
2CH
2DH
2EH
2FH
30H
31H
32H
33H
34H
35H
36H
37H
38H
39H
3AH
3BH
3CH
3DH
3EH
3FH
IAR0
MP0
IAR1
MP1
BP
ACC
PCL
TBLP
TBLH
TBHP
STATUS
SMOD
LVDC
INTEG
WDTC
TBC
INTC0
INTC1
SMOD1
LVRC
MFI0
MFI1
MFI2
Unused
PAWU
PAPU
PA
PAC
PBPU
PB
PBC
PCPU
PC
PCC
PDPU
PD
PDC
PEPU
PE
PEC
PFPU
PF
PFC
PGPU
PG
PGC
Unused
Unused
Unused
Bank 1
40H
41H
42H
43H
EEC
EEA
EED
Unused
47H
48H
49H
4AH
4BH
4CH
4DH
4EH
4FH
50H
51H
52H
53H
54H
55H
56H
57H
TM1C0
TM1C1
TM1C2
TM1DL
TM1DH
TM1AL
TM1AH
TM1BL
TM1BH
TM2C0
TM2C1
TM2DL
TM2DH
TM2AL
TM2AH
Unused
5FH
60H
61H
LCDC
Unused
7FH
: Unused, read as 00H
PAFS
PBFS
PCFS
PDFS
PEFS
PFFS
PGFS
Unused
SFS
TM0C0
TM0C1
TM0DL
TM0DH
TM0AL
TM0AH
HT69F40A
Special
Purpose
Data
Memory
HT69F40A
Special
Purpose Data
Memory
Rev. 1.00
41
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Bank 0, 1, 2, 3
00H
01H
02H
03H
04H
IAR0
MP0
IAR1
MP1
BP
05H
06H
07H
08H
09H
0AH
0BH
0CH
0DH
0EH
0FH
10H
11H
12H
13H
14H
ACC
PCL
TBLP
TBLH
TBHP
STATUS
SMOD
LVDC
INTEG
WDTC
TBC
INTC0
INTC1
SMOD1
LVRC
15H
16H
17H
18H
19H
1AH
1BH
1CH
1DH
1EH
1FH
20H
21H
22H
23H
24H
25H
26H
27H
28H
29H
2AH
2BH
2CH
2DH
2EH
2FH
30H
31H
32H
33H
34H
35H
36H
37H
38H
39H
3AH
3BH
3CH
3DH
3EH
3FH
MFI0
MFI1
MFI2
Unused
PAWU
PAPU
PA
PAC
PBPU
PB
PBC
PCPU
PC
PCC
PDPU
PD
PDC
PEPU
PE
PEC
PFPU
PF
PFC
PGPU
PG
PGC
PHPU
PH
PHC
PAFS
PBFS
PCFS
PDFS
PEFS
PFFS
PGFS
PHFS
SFS
TM0C0
TM0C1
TM0DL
TM0DH
TM0AL
TM0AH
Bank 0, 2, 3
40H
41H
42H
43H
Bank 1
EEC
EEA
EED
Unused
47H
48H
49H
4AH
4BH
4CH
4DH
4EH
4FH
50H
51H
52H
53H
54H
55H
56H
57H
58H
TM1C0
TM1C1
TM1C2
TM1DL
TM1DH
TM1AL
TM1AH
TM1BL
TM1BH
TM2C0
TM2C1
TM2DL
TM2DH
TM2AL
TM2AH
TM2RP
Unused
5FH
60H
61H
LCDC
Unused
7FH
: Unused, read as 00H
HT69F50A
Special Purpose Data Memory
HT69F40A Special Purpose Data Memory
Rev. 1.00
42
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Special Function Register Description
Most of the Special Function Register details will be described in the relevant functional section;
however several registers require a separate description in this section.
Indirect Addressing Registers – IAR0, IAR1
The Indirect Addressing Registers, IAR0 and IAR1, although having their locations in normal RAM
register space, do not actually physically exist as normal registers. The method of indirect addressing
for RAM data manipulation uses these Indirect Addressing Registers and Memory Pointers, in
contrast to direct memory addressing, where the actual memory address is specified. Actions on the
IAR0 and IAR1 registers will result in no actual read or write operation to these registers but rather
to the memory location specified by their corresponding Memory Pointers, MP0 or MP1. Acting as a
pair, IAR0 and MP0 can together access data from Bank 0 while the IAR1 and MP1 register pair can
access data from any bank. As the Indirect Addressing Registers are not physically implemented,
reading the Indirect Addressing Registers indirectly will return a result of “00H” and writing to the
registers indirectly will result in no operation.
Memory Pointers – MP0, MP1
Two Memory Pointers, known as MP0 and MP1 are provided. These Memory Pointers are
physically implemented in the Data Memory and can be manipulated in the same way as normal
registers providing a convenient way with which to address and track data. When any operation to
the relevant Indirect Addressing Registers is carried out, the actual address that the microcontroller
is directed to, is the address specified by the related Memory Pointer. MP0, together with Indirect
Addressing Register, IAR0, are used to access data from Bank 0, while MP1 and IAR1 are used to
access data from all banks according to BP register. Direct Addressing can only be used with Bank 0,
all other Banks must be addressed indirectly using MP1 and IAR1.
Indirect Addressing Program Example
data .section data
adres1 db ?
adres2 db ?
adres3 db ?
adres4 db ?
block
db ?
code .section at 0 code
org 00h
start:
mov
mov
mov
mov
a,04h; setup size of block
block,a
a,offset adres1
; Accumulator loaded with first RAM address
mp0,a
; setup memory pointer with first RAM address
loop:
clr IAR0
; clear the data at address defined by MP0
inc mp0; increment memory pointer
sdz block ; check if last memory location has been cleared
jmp loop
continue:
The important point to note here is that in the example shown above, no reference is made to specific
RAM addresses.
Rev. 1.00
43
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Bank Pointer – BP
Depending upon which device is used, the Data Memory is divided into several banks. Selecting
the required Data Memory area is achieved using the Bank Pointer. Bits 0~1 of the Bank Pointer are
used to select Data Memory Banks 0~3.
The Data Memory is initialised to Bank 0 after a reset, except for a WDT time-out reset in the Power
Down Mode, in which case, the Data Memory bank remains unaffected. It should be noted that the
Special Function Data Memory is not affected by the bank selection, which means that the Special
Function Registers can be accessed from within any bank. Directly addressing the Data Memory
will always result in Bank 0 being accessed irrespective of the value of the Bank Pointer. Accessing
data from banks other than Bank 0 must be implemented using Indirect addressing.
As both the Program Memory and Data Memory share the same Bank Pointer Register, care must be
taken during programming.
Bit
Device
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
HT69F30A
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DMBP0
HT69F40A
—
—
—
—
—
—
DMBP1
DMBP0
HT69F50A
—
—
—
—
—
—
DMBP1
DMBP0
BP Register List
BP Register
• HT69F30A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DMBP0
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
4
3
2
1
0
Bit 7~1
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 0
DMBP0: Data memory bank point
0: Bank 0
1: Bank 1
• HT69F40A
Bit
Rev. 1.00
7
6
5
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
DMBP1
DMBP0
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~2
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 1~0
DMBP1, DMBP0: Data memory bank point
00: Bank 0
01: Bank 1
10: Bank 2
11: Undefined
44
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
• HT69F50A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
DMBP1
DMBP0
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~2
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 1~0
DMBP1, DMBP0: Data memory bank point
00: Bank 0
01: Bank 1
10: Bank 2
11: Bank 3
Accumulator – ACC
The Accumulator is central to the operation of any microcontroller and is closely related with
operations carried out by the ALU. The Accumulator is the place where all intermediate results
from the ALU are stored. Without the Accumulator it would be necessary to write the result of
each calculation or logical operation such as addition, subtraction, shift, etc., to the Data Memory
resulting in higher programming and timing overheads. Data transfer operations usually involve
the temporary storage function of the Accumulator; for example, when transferring data between
one user defined register and another, it is necessary to do this by passing the data through the
Accumulator as no direct transfer between two registers is permitted.
Program Counter Low Register – PCL
To provide additional program control functions, the low byte of the Program Counter is made
accessible to programmers by locating it within the Special Purpose area of the Data Memory. By
manipulating this register, direct jumps to other program locations are easily implemented. Loading
a value directly into this PCL register will cause a jump to the specified Program Memory location,
however, as the register is only 8-bit wide, only jumps within the current Program Memory page are
permitted. When such operations are used, note that a dummy cycle will be inserted.
Look-up Table Registers – TBLP, TBHP, TBLH
These three special function registers are used to control operation of the look-up table which is
stored in the Program Memory. TBLP and TBHP are the table pointer and indicates the location
where the table data is located. Their value must be setup before any table read commands are
executed. Their value can be changed, for example using the “INC” or “DEC” instructions, allowing
for easy table data pointing and reading. TBLH is the location where the high order byte of the table
data is stored after a table read data instruction has been executed. Note that the lower order table
data byte is transferred to a user defined location.
Rev. 1.00
45
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Status Register – STATUS
This 8-bit register contains the zero flag (Z), carry flag (C), auxiliary carry flag (AC), overflow flag
(OV), power down flag (PDF), and watchdog time-out flag (TO). These arithmetic/logical operation
and system management flags are used to record the status and operation of the microcontroller.
With the exception of the TO and PDF flags, bits in the status register can be altered by instructions
like most other registers. Any data written into the status register will not change the TO or PDF flag.
In addition, operations related to the status register may give different results due to the different
instruction operations. The TO flag can be affected only by a system power-up, a WDT time-out or
by executing the “CLR WDT” or “HALT” instruction. The PDF flag is affected only by executing
the “HALT” or “CLR WDT” instruction or during a system power-up.
The Z, OV, AC and C flags generally reflect the status of the latest operations.
• C is set if an operation results in a carry during an addition operation or if a borrow does not take
place during a subtraction operation; otherwise C is cleared. C is also affected by a rotate through
carry instruction.
• AC is set if an operation results in a carry out of the low nibbles in addition, or no borrow from
the high nibble into the low nibble in subtraction; otherwise AC is cleared.
• Z is set if the result of an arithmetic or logical operation is zero; otherwise Z is cleared.
• OV is set if an operation results in a carry into the highest-order bit but not a carry out of the
highest-order bit, or vice versa; otherwise OV is cleared.
• PDF is cleared by a system power-up or executing the “CLR WDT” instruction. PDF is set by
executing the “HALT” instruction.
• TO is cleared by a system power-up or executing the “CLR WDT” or “HALT” instruction. TO is
set by a WDT time-out.
In addition, on entering an interrupt sequence or executing a subroutine call, the status register will
not be pushed onto the stack automatically. If the contents of the status registers are important and if
the subroutine can corrupt the status register, precautions must be taken to correctly save it.
Rev. 1.00
46
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
STATUS Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
TO
PDF
OV
Z
AC
C
R/W
—
—
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
0
0
x
x
x
x
“x” unknown
Rev. 1.00
Bit 7, 6
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 5
TO: Watchdog Time-Out flag
0: After power up or executing the “CLR WDT” or “HALT” instruction
1: A watchdog time-out occurred
Bit 4
PDF: Power down flag
0: After power up or executing the “CLR WDT” instruction
1: By executing the “HALT” instruction
Bit 3
OV: Overflow flag
0: No overflow
1: An operation results in a carry into the highest-order bit but not a carry out of the
highest-order bit or vice versa
Bit 2
Z: Zero flag
0: The result of an arithmetic or logical operation is not zero
1: The result of an arithmetic or logical operation is zero
Bit 1
AC: Auxiliary flag
0: No auxiliary carry
1: An operation results in a carry out of the low nibbles in addition, or no borrow
from the high nibble into the low nibble in subtraction
Bit 0
C: Carry flag
0: No carry-out
1: An operation results in a carry during an addition operation or if a borrow does
not take place during a subtraction operation
C is also affected by a rotate through carry instruction.
47
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
EEPROM Data Memory
The EEPROM Data Memory capacity is up to 128×8 bits for this series of devices. Unlike the
Program Memory and RAM Data Memory, the EEPROM Data Memory is not directly mapped
into memory space and is therefore not directly addressable in the same way as the other types of
memory. Read andWrite operations to the EEPROM are carried out in single byte operations using
an address and data register in Bank 0 and a single control register in Bank 1.
Device
Capacity
Address
HT69F30A
64×8
00H~3FH
HT69F40A
128×8
00H~7FH
HT69F50A
128×8
00H~7FH
EEPROM Registers
Three registers control the overall operation of the internal EEPROM Data Memory. These are the
address register, EEA, the data register, EED and a single control register, EEC. As both the EEA
and EED registers are located in Bank 0, they can be directly accessed in the same was as any other
Special Function Register. The EEC register however, being located in Bank1, cannot be addressed
directly and can only be read from or written to indirectly using the MP1 Memory Pointer and
Indirect Addressing Register, IAR1. Because the EEC control register is located at address 40H in
Bank 1, the MP1 Memory Pointer must first be set to the value 40H and the Bank Pointer register,
BP, set to the value, 01H, before any operations on the EEC register are executed.
EEPROM Register List
• HT69F30A
Register
Name
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EEA
—
—
EEA5
EEA4
EEA3
EEA2
EEA1
EEA0
EED
EED7
EED6
EED5
EED4
EED3
EED2
EED1
EED0
EEC
—
—
—
—
WREN
WR
RDEN
RD
• HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Bit
Register
Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EEA
—
EEA6
EEA5
EEA4
EEA3
EEA2
EEA1
EEA0
EED
EED7
EED6
EED5
EED4
EED3
EED2
EED1
EED0
EEC
—
—
—
—
WREN
WR
RDEN
RD
EEA Register
• HT69F30A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
EEA5
EEA4
EEA3
EEA2
EEA1
EEA0
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
x
x
x
x
x
x
“x”: unknown
Rev. 1.00
Bit 7~6
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 5~0
EEA5~EEA0: Data EEPROM address bit 5~bit 0
48
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
• HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
EEA6
EEA5
EEA4
EEA3
EEA2
EEA1
EEA0
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
—
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
“x”: unknown
Bit 7
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 6~0
EEA6~EEA0: Data EEPROM address bit 6~bit 0
EED Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
EED5
EED4
EED5
EED4
EED3
EED2
EED1
EED0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
“x”: unknown
Bit 7~0
EED7~EED0: Data EEPROM data bit 7~bit 0
EEC Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
WREN
WR
RDEN
RD
R/W
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~4
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 3
WREN: Data EEPROM write operation enable
0: Disable
1: Enable
This is the Data EEPROM Write Operation Enable bit which must be set high before
Datat EEPROM write operations are carried out. Clearing this bit to zero will inhibit
Data EEPROM write operations.
Bit 2
WR: Data EEPROM write control
0: Write cycle has finished
1: Activate a write cycle
This is the Data EEPROM Write Control bit and when set high by the application
program will activate a write cycle. This bit will be automatically reset to zero by the
hardware after the write cycle has finished. Setting this bit high will have no effect if
the WREN bit has not first been set high.
Bit 1
RDEN: Data EEPROM read operation enable
0: Disable
1: Enable
This is the Data EEPROM Read Operation Enable bit which must be set high before
Datat EEPROM read operations are carried out. Clearing this bit to zero will inhibit
Data EEPROM read operations.
Bit 0
RD: Data EEPROM read control
0: Read cycle has finished
1: Activate a read cycle
This is the Data EEPROM Read Control bit and when set high by the application
program will activate a read cycle. This bit will be automatically reset to zero by the
hardware after the read cycle has finished. Setting this bit high will have no effect if
the RDEN bit has not first been set high.
Note: The WREN, WR, RDEN and RD bits can not be set to “1” at the same time in one instruction.
The WR and RD bits can not be set to “1” at the same time.
Rev. 1.00
49
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Reading Data from the EEPROM
To read data from the EEPROM, the read enable bit, RDEN, in the EEC register must first be set
high to enable the read function. The EEPROM address of the data to be read must then be placed
in the EEAregister. If the RD bit in the EEC register is now set high, a read cycle will be initiated.
Setting the RD bit high will not initiate a read operation if the RDEN bit has not been set. When
the read cycle terminates, the RD bit will be automatically cleared to zero, after which the data can
be read from the EED register. The data will remain in the EED register until another read or write
operation is executed. The application program can poll the RD bit to determine when the data is
valid for reading.
Writing Data to the EEPROM
The EEPROM address of the data to be written must first be placed in the EEA register and the data
placed in the EED register. To write data to the EEPROM, the write enable bit, WREN, in the EEC
register must first be set high to enable the write function. After this, the WR bit in the EEC register
must be immediately set high to initiate a write cycle. These two instructions must be executed
consecutively. The global interrupt bit EMI should also first be cleared before implementing any
write operations, and then set again after the write cycle has started. Note that setting the WR bit
high will not initiate a write cycle if the WREN bit has not been set. As the EEPROM write cycle is
controlled using an internal timer whose operation is asynchronous to microcontroller system clock,
a certain time will elapse before the data will have been written into the EEPROM. Detecting when
the write cycle has finished can be implemented either by polling the WR bit in the EEC register or
by using the EEPROM interrupt. When the write cycle terminates, the WR bit will be automatically
cleared to zero by the microcontroller, informing the user that the data has been written to the
EEPROM. The application program can therefore poll the WR bit to determine when the write cycle
has ended.
Write Protection
Protection against inadvertent write operation is provided in several ways. After the device is
powered-on the Write Enable bit in the control register will be cleared preventing any write
operations. Also at power-on the Bank Pointer, BP, will be reset to zero, which means that Data
Memory Bank 0 will be selected. As the EEPROM control register is located in Bank 1, this adds a
further measure of protection against spurious write operations. During normal program operation,
ensuring that the Write Enable bit in the control register is cleared will safeguard against incorrect
write operations.
EEPROM Interrupt
The EEPROM write interrupt is generated when an EEPROM write cycle has ended. The
EEPROM interrupt must first be enabled by setting the DEE bit in the relevant interrupt register.
However as the EEPROM is contained within a Multi-function Interrupt, the associated multifunction interrupt enable bit must also be set. When an EEPROM write cycle ends, the DEF
request flag and its associated multi-function interrupt request flag will both be set. If the global,
EEPROM and Multi-function interrupts are enabled and the stack is not full, a jump to the
associated Multi-function Interrupt vector will take place. When the interrupt is serviced only
the Multi-function interrupt flag will be automatically reset, the EEPROM interrupt flag must be
manually reset by the application program. More details can be obtained in the Interrupt section.
Rev. 1.00
50
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Programming Considerations
Care must be taken that data is not inadvertently written to the EEPROM. Protection can be
enhanced by ensuring that the Write Enable bit is normally cleared to zero when not writing. Also
the Bank Pointer could be normally cleared to zero as this would inhibit access to Bank 1 where the
EEPROM control register exist. Although certainly not necessary, consideration might be given in the
application program to the checking of the validity of new write data by a simple read back process.
When writing data the WR bit must be set high immediately after the WREN bit has been set high,
to ensure the write cycle executes correctly. The global interrupt bit EMI should also be cleared
before a write cycle is executed and then re-enabled after the write cycle starts.
Programming Examples
Reading Data from the EEPROM – Polling Mothod
MOV A, EEPROM_ADRES
MOV EEA, A
MOV A, 040H
MOV MP1, A
MOV A, 01H
MOV BP, A
SET IAR1.1
SET IAR1.0
BACK:
SZ IAR1.0
JMP BACK
CLR IAR1
CLR BP
MOV A, EED
MOV READ_DATA, A
; user defined address
; setup memory pointer MP1
; MP1 points to EEC register
; setup Bank Pointer
; set RDEN bit, enable read operations
; start Read Cycle - set RD bit
; check for read cycle end
; disable EEPROM read/write
; move read data to register
Writing Data to the EEPROM – Polling Mothod
CLR
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
SET
SET
EMI
A, EEPROM_ADRES
EEA, A
A, EEPROM_DATA
EED, A
A, 040H
MP1, A
A, 01H
BP, A
IAR1.3
IAR1.2
SET EMI
BACK:
SZ IAR1.2
JMP BACK
CLR IAR1
CLR BP
Rev. 1.00
; user defined address
; user defined data
; setup memory pointer MP1
; MP1 points to EEC register
; setup Bank Pointer
; set WREN bit, enable write operations
; Start Write Cycle - set WR bit - executed immediately
; after set WREN bit
; check for write cycle end
; disable EEPROM read/write
51
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Oscillator
Various oscillator options offer the user a wide range of functions according to their various
application requirements. The flexible features of the oscillator functions ensure that the best
optimisation can be achieved in terms of speed and power saving. Oscillator selections and operation
are selected through a combination of configuration options and registers.
Oscillator Overview
In addition to being the source of the main system clock the oscillators also provide clock sources
for the Watchdog Timer and Time Base Interrupts. External oscillators requiring some external
components as well as fully integrated internal oscillators, requiring no external components,
are provided to form a wide range of both fast and slow system oscillators. All oscillator options
are selected through the configuration options. The higher frequency oscillators provide higher
performance but carry with it the disadvantage of higher power requirements, while the opposite
is of course true for the lower frequency oscillators. With the capability of dynamically switching
between fast and slow system clock, the device has the flexibility to optimize the performance/power
ratio, a feature especially important in power sensitive portable applications.
Type
Name
Freq.
Pins
External Crystal
HXT
400kHz~16MHz
OSC1/OSC2
External RC
ERC
8MHz
OSC1
400kHz~20MHz
OSC1
External Clock
EC
Internal High Speed RC
HIRC
4, 8 or 12MHz
External Low Speed Crystal
LXT
32.768kHz
Internal Low Speed RC
LIRC
32kHz
—
XT1/XT2
—
Oscillator Types
System Clock Configurations
There are five methods of generating the system clock, three high speed oscillators and two low
speed oscillators. The high speed oscillators are is the external crystal/ceramic oscillator, external
RC network oscillator and the internal 4MHz, 8MHz or 12MHz RC oscillator. The two low speed
oscillators are the internal 32kHz RC oscillator and the external 32.768kHz crystal oscillator.
Selecting whether the low or high speed oscillator is used as the system oscillator is implemented
using the HLCLK bit and CKS2~CKS0 bits in the SMOD register and as the system clock can be
dynamically selected.
Rev. 1.00
52
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
High Speed Oscillation
(HOSC)
Fast Wake-up from SLEEP Mode or
IDLE Mode Control (for HXT only)
fH/2
HXT
fH/4
ERC
fH/8
fH
Prescaler
HIRC
fH/16
fSYS
fH/32
fH/64
EC
High Speed Oscillation
Configuration Option
CKS[2:0], HLCLK
Low Speed Oscillation
(LOSC)
TBCK
LIRC
fSUB
fTB
LXT
Time Base
fSYS/4
Low Speed Oscillation
Configuration Option
fs
÷8
WDT
LCD Driver
External Crystal/Ceramic Oscillator – HXT
The External Crystal/Ceramic System Oscillator is one of the high frequency oscillator choices,
which is selected via configuration option. For most crystal oscillator configurations, the simple
connection of a crystal across OSC1 and OSC2 will create the necessary phase shift and feedback for
oscillation, without requiring external capacitors. However, for some crystal types and frequencies,
to ensure oscillation, it may be necessary to add two small value capacitors, C1 and C2. Using a
ceramic resonator will usually require two small value capacitors, C1 and C2, to be connected as
shown for oscillation to occur. The values of C1 and C2 should be selected in consultation with the
crystal or resonator manufacturer's specification. An additional configuration option must be setup
to configure the device according to whether the oscillator frequency is high, defined as equal to or
above 1MHz, or low, which is defined as below 1MHz.
     Crystal/Resonator Oscillator – HXT
Rev. 1.00
53
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Crystal Oscillator C1 and C2 Values
Crystal Frequency
C1
C2
12MHz
0pF
0pF
8MHz
0pF
0pF
4MHz
0pF
0pF
1MHz
100pF
100pF
455kHz (see Note2)
100pF
100pF
Note: 1. C1 and C2 values are for guidance only.
2. XTAL mode configuration option: 455kHz.
Crystal Recommended Capacitor Values
External RC Oscillator – ERC
Using the ERC oscillator only requires that a resistor, with a value between 56kΩ and 2.4MΩ,
is connected between OSC1 and VDD, and a capacitor is connected between OSC1 and ground,
providing a low cost oscillator configuration. It is only the external resistor that determines the
oscillation frequency; the external capacitor has no influence over the frequency and is connected
for stability purposes only. Device trimming during the manufacturing process and the inclusion
of internal frequency compensation circuits are used to ensure that the influence of the power
supply voltage, temperature and process variations on the oscillation frequency are minimised. As a
resistance/frequency reference point, it can be noted that with an external 150kΩ resistor connected
and with a 5V voltage power supply and temperature of 25°C degrees, the oscillator will have a
frequency of 4MHz within a tolerance of 2%. Here only the OSC1 pin is used, which is shared with
I/O pin PB0, leaving pin PB1 free for use as a normal I/O pin.
External RC Oscillator — ERC
Internal RC Oscillator – HIRC
The internal RC oscillator is a fully integrated system oscillator requiring no external components.
The internal RC oscillator has three fixed frequencies of either 4MHz, 8MHz or 12MHz. Device
trimming during the manufacturing process and the inclusion of internal frequency compensation
circuits are used to ensure that the influence of the power supply voltage, temperature and process
variations on the oscillation frequency are minimised. As a result, at a power supply of either 3V or
5V and at a temperature of 25°C degrees, the fixed oscillation frequency of 4MHz, 8MHz or 12MHz
will have a tolerance within 2%. Note that if this internal system clock option is selected, as it
requires no external pins for its operation, I/O pins PB0 and PB1 are free for use as normal I/O pins.
Rev. 1.00
54
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
External 32.768kHz Crystal Oscillator – LXT
The External 32.768kHz Crystal System Oscillator is one of the low frequency oscillator choices,
which is selected via configuration option. This clock source has a fixed frequency of 32.768kHz
and requires a 32.768kHz crystal to be connected between pins XT1 and XT2. The external resistor
and capacitor components connected to the 32.768kHz crystal are necessary to provide oscillation.
For applications where precise frequencies are essential, these components may be required to
provide frequency compensation due to different crystal manufacturing tolerances. During power-up
there is a time delay associated with the LXT oscillator waiting for it to start-up.
When the microcontroller enters the SLEEP or IDLE Mode, the system clock is switched off to stop
microcontroller activity and to conserve power. However, in many microcontroller applications it
may be necessary to keep the internal timers operational even when the microcontroller is in the
SLEEP or IDLE Mode. To do this, another clock, independent of the system clock, must be provided.
However, for some crystals, to ensure oscillation and accurate frequency generation, it is necessary
to add two small value external capacitors, C1 and C2. The exact values of C1 and C2 should be
selected in consultation with the crystal or resonator manufacturer's specification. The external
parallel feedback resistor, Rp, is required.
Some configuration options determine if the XT1/XT2 pins are used for the LXT oscillator or as I/O
pins.
• If the LXT oscillator is not used for any clock source, the XT1/XT2 pins can be used as
normal I/O pins.
• If the LXT oscillator is used for any clock source, the 32.768kHz crystal should be connected to
the XT1/XT2 pins.
‚   
­ €
  ‚ 
External LXT Oscillator
LXT Oscillator C1 and C2 Values
Crystal Frequency
C1
C2
32.768kHz
10pF
10pF
Note:1. C1 and C2 values are for guidance only.
2. RP=5M~10MΩ is recommended.
32.768kHz Crystal Recommended Capacitor Values
Rev. 1.00
55
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
LXT Oscillator Low Power Function
The LXT oscillator can function in one of two modes, the Quick Start Mode and the Low Power
Mode. The mode selection is executed using the LXTLP bit in the TBC register.
LXTLP Bit
LXT Mode
0
Quick Start
1
Low-power
After power on the LXTLP bit will be automatically cleared to zero ensuring that the LXT oscillator
is in the Quick Start operating mode. In the Quick Start Mode the LXT oscillator will power up
and stabilise quickly. However, after the LXT oscillator has fully powered up it can be placed
into the Low-power mode by setting the LXTLP bit high. The oscillator will continue to run but
with reduced current consumption, as the higher current consumption is only required during the
LXT oscillator start-up. In power sensitive applications, such as battery applications, where power
consumption must be kept to a minimum, it is therefore recommended that the application program
sets the LXTLP bit high about 2 seconds after power-on.
It should be noted that, no matter what condition the LXTLP bit is set to, the LXT oscillator will
always function normally, the only difference is that it will take more time to start up if in the
Low-power mode.
Internal 32kHz Oscillator – LIRC
The Internal 32kHz System Oscillator is one of the low frequency oscillator choices, which is
selected via configuration option. It is a fully integrated RC oscillator with a typical frequency of
32kHz at 5V, requiring no external components for its implementation. Device trimming during
the manufacturing process and the inclusion of internal frequency compensation circuits are used
to ensure that the influence of the power supply voltage, temperature and process variations on the
oscillation frequency are minimised. As a result, at a power supply of 5V and at a temperature of
25°C degrees, the fixed oscillation frequency of 32kHz will have a tolerance within 10%.
External Clock – EC
The system clock can also be supplied by an externally supplied clock giving users a method of
synchronizing their external hardware to the microcontroller operation. This is selected using
a configuration option and supplying the clock on pin OSC1. Pin OSC2 should be left floating
if the external oscillator is used. The internal oscillator circuit contains a filter circuit to reduce
the possibility of erratic operation due to noise on the oscillator pin, however as the filter circuit
consumes a certain amount of power, a oscillator configuration option exists to turn this filter off.
Not using the internal filter should be considered in power sensitive applications and where the
externally supplied clock is of a high integrity and supplied by a low impedance source.
Supplementary Oscillators
The low speed oscillators, in addition to providing a system clock source are also used to provide a
clock source to two other device functions. These are the Watchdog Timer, the LCD driver and the
Time Base Interrupts.
Rev. 1.00
56
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Operating Modes and System Clocks
Present day applications require that their microcontrollers have high performance but often still
demand that they consume as little power as possible, conflicting requirements that are especially
true in battery powered portable applications. The fast clocks required for high performance will
by their nature increase current consumption and of course vice-versa, lower speed clocks reduce
current consumption. As Holtek has provided these devices with both high and low speed clock
sources and the means to switch between them dynamically, the user can optimise the operation of
their microcontroller to achieve the best performance/power ratio.
System Clock
The device has many different clock sources for both the CPU and peripheral function operation.
By providing the user with a wide range of clock options using configuration options and register
programming, a clock system can be configured to obtain maximum application performance.
The main system clock, can come from either a high frequency, fH, or low frequency, fSUB, source,
and is selected using the HLCLK bit and CKS2~CKS0 bits in the SMOD register. The high speed
system clock can be sourced from an HXT, ERC or HIRC oscillator, selected via a configuration
option. The low speed system clock source can be sourced from the clock, fSUB. If fSUB is selected
then it can be sourced by either the LXT or LIRC oscillators, selected via a configuration option.
The other choice, which is a divided version of the high speed system oscillator has a range of
fH/2~fH/64.
The fSUB clock is used to provide a substitute clock for the microcontroller just after a wake-up has
occurred to enable faster wake-up times.
High Speed Oscillation
(HOSC)
Fast Wake-up from SLEEP Mode or
IDLE Mode Control (for HXT only)
fH/2
HXT
fH/4
ERC
fH/8
fH
Prescaler
HIRC
fH/16
fSYS
fH/32
fH/64
EC
High Speed Oscillation
Configuration Option
CKS[2:0], HLCLK
Low Speed Oscillation
(LOSC)
TBCK
LIRC
fSUB
fTB
LXT
Time Base
fSYS/4
Low Speed Oscillation
Configuration Option
fs
÷8
WDT
LCD Driver
System Clock Configurations
Note: When the system clock source fSYS is switched to fSUB from fH, the high speed oscillation will stop to
conserve the power. Thus there is no fH~fH/64 for peripheral circuit to use.
Rev. 1.00
57
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
System Operation Modes
There are six different modes of operation for the microcontroller, each one with its own
special characteristics and which can be chosen according to the specific performance and
power requirements of the application. There are two modes allowing normal operation of the
microcontroller, the NORMAL Mode and SLOW Mode. The remaining four modes, the SLEEP0,
SLEEP1, IDLE0 and IDLE1 Mode are used when the microcontroller CPU is switched off to
conserve power.
Operating Mode
Description
CPU
fSYS
fSUB
fS
NORMAL Mode
On
fH~fH/64
On
On
SLOW Mode
On
fSUB
On
On
IDLE0 Mode
Off
Off
On
On
IDLE1 Mode
Off
On
On
On
SLEEP0 Mode
Off
Off
Off
Off
SLEEP1 Mode
Off
Off
On
On
NORMAL Mode
As the name suggests this is one of the main operating modes where the microcontroller has all of
its functions operational and where the system clock is provided by one of the high speed oscillators.
This mode operates allowing the microcontroller to operate normally with a clock source will
come from one of the high speed oscillators, either the HXT, ERC, EC or HIRC oscillators. The
high speed oscillator will however first be divided by a ratio ranging from 1 to 64, the actual ratio
being selected by the CKS2~CKS0 and HLCLK bits in the SMOD register. Although a high speed
oscillator is used, running the microcontroller at a divided clock ratio reduces the operating current.
SLOW Mode
This is also a mode where the microcontroller operates normally although now with a slower speed
clock source. The clock source used will be from one of the low speed oscillators, either the LXT
or the LIRC. Running the microcontroller in this mode allows it to run with much lower operating
currents. In the SLOW Mode, the fH is off.
SLEEP0 Mode
The SLEEP Mode is entered when an HALT instruction is executed and when the IDLEN bit in the
SMOD register is low. In the SLEEP0 mode the CPU will be stopped, and the fSUB and fS clocks will
be stopped too, and the Watchdog Timer function is disabled. In this mode, the LVDEN is must set
to "0". If the LVDEN is set to "1", it won't enter the SLEEP0 Mode.
SLEEP1 Mode
The SLEEP1 Mode is entered when an HALT instruction is executed and when the IDLEN bit in the
SMOD register is low. In the SLEEP1 mode the CPU will be stopped. However the fS will continue
to operate if the LVDEN is “1” or the Watchdog Timer function is enabled as its clock source is from
the fSUB.
IDLE0 Mode
The IDLE0 Mode is entered when a HALT instruction is executed and when the IDLEN bit in the
SMOD register is high and the FSYSON bit in the SMOD1 register is low. In the IDLE0 Mode the
system oscillator will be inhibited from driving the CPU but some peripheral functions will remain
operational such as the Watchdog Timer, TMs and LCD driver. In the IDLE0 Mode, the system
oscillator will be stopped while the Watchdog Timer clock, fS, will be on.
Rev. 1.00
58
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
IDLE1 Mode
The IDLE1 Mode is entered when an HALT instruction is executed and when the IDLEN bit in the
SMOD register is high and the FSYSON bit in the SMOD1 register is high. In the IDLE1 Mode
the system oscillator will be inhibited from driving the CPU but may continue to provide a clock
source to keep some peripheral functions operational such as the Watchdog Timer, TMs and SIM. In
the IDLE1 Mode, the system oscillator will continue to run, and this system oscillator may be high
speed or low speed system oscillator. In the IDLE1 Mode the Watchdog Timer clock, fS, will also be
on.
Control Register
A register pair, SMOD and SMOD1, is used for overall control of the internal clocks within the
device.
SMOD Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
FSTEN
LTO
HTO
IDLEN
HLCLK
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
Bit 7~5
CKS2~CKS0: The system clock selection when HLCLK is "0"
000: fSUB (fLXT or fLIRC)
001: fSUB (fLXT or fLIRC)
010: fH/64
011: fH/32
100: fH/16
101: fH/8
110: fH/4
111: fH/2
These three bits are used to select which clock is used as the system clock source.
In addition to the system clock source the LIRC, a divided version of the high speed
system oscillator can also be chosen as the system clock source.
Bit 4
FSTEN: Fast Wake-up Control (only for HXT)
0: Disable
1: Enable
This is the Fast Wake-up Control bit which determines if the fSUB clock source is
initially used after the device wakes up. When the bit is high, the fSUB clock source can
be used as a temporary system clock to provide a faster wake up time as the fSUB clock
is available.
Bit 3
LTO: Low speed system oscillator ready flag
0: Not ready
1: Ready
This is the low speed system oscillator ready flag which indicates when the low speed
system oscillator is stable after power on reset or a wake-up has occurred. The flag
will be low when in the SLEEP0 Mode but after a wake-up has occurred, the flag will
change to a high level after 1~2 clock cycles if the LIRC oscillator is used.
59
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
HTO: High speed system oscillator ready flag
0: Not ready
1: Ready
This is the high speed system oscillator ready flag which indicates when the high speed
system oscillator is stable. This flag is cleared to “0” by hardware when the device is
powered on and then changes to a high level after the high speed system oscillator is
stable. Therefore this flag will always be read as “1” by the application program after
device power-on. The flag will be low when in the SLEEP or IDLE0 Mode but after
a wake-up has occurred, the flag will change to a high level after 1024 clock cycles if
the HXT oscillator is used.
IDLEN: IDLE Mode control
0: Disable
1: Enable
This is the IDLE Mode Control bit and determines what happens when the HALT
instruction is executed. If this bit is high, when a HALT instruction is executed the
device will enter the IDLE Mode. In the IDLE1 Mode the CPU will stop running
but the system clock will continue to keep the peripheral functions operational, if
FSYSON bit is high. If FSYSON bit is low, the CPU and the system clock will all stop
in IDLE0 mode. If the bit is low the device will enter the SLEEP Mode when a HALT
instruction is executed.
HLCLK: System clock selection
0: fH/2~fH/64 or fSUB
1: fH
This bit is used to select if the fH clock or the fH/2~fH/64 or fSUB clock is used as
the system clock. When the bit is high the fH clock will be selected and if low the
fH/2~fH/64 or fSUB clock will be selected. When system clock switches from the fH clock
to the fSUB clock and the fH clock will be automatically switched off to conserve power.
SMOD1 Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
FSYSON
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
LVRF
LRF
WRF
R/W
R/W
POR
0
—
—
—
—
R/W
x
0
0
"x" unknown
Bit 7
FSYSON: fSYS Control in IDLE Mode
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 6~3
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 2
LVRF: LVR function reset flag
0: Not occurred
1: Occurred
This bit is set to 1 when a specific Low Voltage Reset situation occurs. This bit can
only be cleared to 0 by the application program.
LRF: LVR Control register software reset flag
0: Not occurred
1: Occurred
This bit is set to 1 if the LVRC register contains any non defined LVR voltage register
values. This in effect acts like a software-reset function. This bit can only be cleared to
0 by the application program.
WRF: WDT Control register software reset flag
0: Not occurred
1: Occurred
This bit is set to 1 by the WDT Control register software reset and cleared by the
application program. Note that this bit can only be cleared to 0 by the application
program.
Bit 1
bit 0
Rev. 1.00
60
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Fast Wake-up
To minimise power consumption the device can enter the SLEEP or IDLE0 Mode, where the system
clock source to the device will be stopped. However when the device is woken up again, it can take
a considerable time for the original system oscillator to restart, stabilize and allow normal operation
to resume. To ensure the device is up and running as fast as possible a Fast Wake-up function is
provided, which allows fSUB, namely the LIRC oscillator, to act as a temporary clock to first drive the
system until the original system oscillator has stabilised. As the clock source for the Fast Wake-up
function is fSUB, the Fast Wake-up function is only available in the SLEEP1 and IDLE0 modes.
When the device is woken up from the SLEEP0 mode, the FastWake-up function has no effect
because the fSUB clock is stopped. The FastWake-up enable/disable function is controlled using the
FSTEN bit in the SMOD register.
If the HXT oscillator is selected as the NORMAL Mode system clock and if the Fast Wake-up
function is enabled, then it will take one to two tSUB clock cycles of the LIRC oscillator for the
system to wake-up. The system will then initially run under the fSUB clock source until 1024 HXT
clock cycles have elapsed, at which point the HTO flag will switch high and the system will switch
over to operating from the HXT oscillator.
If the ERC/HIRC or EC/LIRC oscillator is used as the system oscillator, then it will take15~16 clock
cycles of the ERC/HIRC oscillator or 1~2 clock cycles of the LIRC osrillator respectively to wake
up the system from the SLEEP or IDLE0 Mode. The Fast Wake-up bit, FSTEN will have no effect
in these cases.
System
Oscillator
FSTEN
Bit
0
Wake-up Time
(SLEEP0 Mode)
Wake-up Time
(SLEEP1 Mode)
Wake-up Time
(IDLE0 Mode)
Wake-up Time
(IDLE1 Mode)
1024 HXT cycles
1024 HXT cycles
1~2 HXT cycles
1
1024 HXT cycles
1~2 fSUB cycles
(System runs with fSUB first for 1024 HXT
cycles and then switches over to run with
the HXT clock )
1~2 HXT cycles
ERC
x
15~16 ERC cycles
15~16 ERC cycles
1~2 ERC cycles
HIRC
x
15~16 HIRC cycles
15~16 HIRC cycles
1~2 HIRC cycles
EC
x
1~2 EC cycles
1~2 EC cycles
1~2 EC cycles
LIRC
x
1~2 LIRC cycles
1~2 LIRC cycles
1~2 LIRC cycles
LXT
x
1024 LXT cycles
1024 LXT cycles
1~2 LXT cycles
HXT
Wake-up Times
Note that if the Watchdog Timer is disabled, which means that the fSUB clock drived from the LXT
or LIRC oscillator is off, then there will be no Fast Wake-up function available when the device
wakes-up from the SLEEP0 Mode.
Operating Mode Switching
The device can switch between operating modes dynamically allowing the user to select the best
performance/power ratio for the present task in hand. In this way microcontroller operations that
do not require high performance can be executed using slower clocks thus requiring less operating
current and prolonging battery life in portable applications.
In simple terms, Mode Switching between the NORMAL Mode and SLOW Mode is executed
using the HLCLK bit and CKS2~CKS0 bits in the SMOD register while Mode Switching from the
NORMAL/SLOW Modes to the SLEEP/IDLE Modes is executed via the HALT instruction. When
a HALT instruction is executed, whether the device enters the IDLE Mode or the SLEEP Mode is
determined by the condition of the IDLEN bit in the SMOD register and FSYSON in the SMOD1
register.
Rev. 1.00
61
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
When the HLCLK bit switches to a low level, which implies that clock source is switched from the
high speed clock source, fH, to the clock source, fH/2~fH/64 or fSUB. If the clock is from the fSUB, the
high speed clock source will stop running to conserve power. When this happens it must be noted
that the fH/16 and fH/64 internal clock sources will also stop running, which may affect the operation
of other internal functions such as the TMs and the LCD driver. The accompanying flowchart shows
what happens when the device moves between the various operating modes.
­ €    
­ €    Operating Mode Switching and Wake-up
The device can switch between operating modes dynamically allowing the user to select the best
performance/power ratio for the present task in hand. In this way microcontroller operations that
do not require high performance can be executed using slower clocks thus requiring less operating
current and prolonging battery life in portable applications.
In simple terms, Mode Switching between the NORMAL Mode and SLOW Mode is executed
using the HLCLK bit and CKS2~CKS0 bits in the SMOD register while Mode Switching from the
NORMAL/SLOW Modes to the SLEEP/IDLE Modes is executed via the HALT instruction. When
a HALT instruction is executed, whether the device enters the IDLE Mode or the SLEEP Mode is
determined by the condition of the IDLEN bit in the SMOD register and FSYSON in the WDTC
register.
When the HLCLK bit switches to a low level, which implies that clock source is switched from the
high speed clock source, fH, to the clock source, fH/2~fH/64 or fL. If the clock is from the fL, the high
speed clock source will stop running to conserve power. When this happens it must be noted that the
fH/16 and fH/64 internal clock sources will also stop running, which may affect the operation of other
internal functions such as the TMs and the SIM. The accompanying flowchart shows what happens
when the device moves between the various operating modes.
Rev. 1.00
62
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
NORMAL Mode to SLOW Mode Switching
When running in the NORMAL Mode, which uses the high speed system oscillator, and therefore
consumes more power, the system clock can switch to run in the SLOW Mode by set the HLCLK bit
to "0" and set the CKS2~CKS0 bits to "000" or "001" in the SMOD register. This will then use the
low speed system oscillator which will consume less power. Users may decide to do this for certain
operations which do not require high performance and can subsequently reduce power consumption.
The SLOW Mode is sourced from the LXT or the LIRC oscillators and therefore requires these
oscillators to be stable before full mode switching occurs. This is monitored using the LTO bit in the
SMOD register.
  
   ­   ­       ­   ­
 €‚ ƒ    ­   ­
 €‚ ƒ    ­   ­
 Rev. 1.00
63
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
  
     ­          ­   € ‚      ­   € ‚      ­   SLOW Mode to NORMAL Mode Switching
In SLOW Mode the system uses either the LXT or LIRC low speed system oscillator. To switch
back to the NORMAL Mode, where the high speed system oscillator is used, the HLCLK bit should
be set to "1" or HLCLK bit is "0", but CKS2~CKS0 is set to "010", "011", "100", "101", "110" or
"111". As a certain amount of time will be required for the high frequency clock to stabilise, the
status of the HTO bit is checked. The amount of time required for high speed system oscillator
stabilization depends upon which high speed system oscillator type is used.
Rev. 1.00
64
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Entering the SLEEP0 Mode
There is only one way for the device to enter the SLEEP0 Mode and that is to execute the “HALT”
instruction in the application program with the IDLEN bit in SMOD register equal to “0” and the
WDT and LVD both off. When this instruction is executed under the conditions described above, the
following will occur:
• The system clock and the fSUB clock will be stopped and the application program will stop at the
“HALT” instruction.
• The Data Memory contents and registers will maintain their present condition.
• The WDT will be cleared and stopped as the WDT is disabled.
• The I/O ports will maintain their present conditions.
• In the status register, the Power Down flag, PDF, will be set and the Watchdog time-out flag, TO,
will be cleared.
Entering the SLEEP1 Mode
There is only one way for the device to enter the SLEEP1 Mode and that is to execute the “HALT”
instruction in the application program with the IDLEN bit in SMOD register equal to “0” and the
WDT or LVD on. When this instruction is executed under the conditions described above, the
following will occur:
• The system clock will be stopped and the application program will stop at the “HALT”
instruction, but the WDT or LVD will remain with the clock source coming from the fSUB clock.
• The Data Memory contents and registers will maintain their present condition.
• The WDT will be cleared and resume counting as the WDT is enabled and its clock source is
selected to come from the fSUB clock.
• The I/O ports will maintain their present conditions.
• In the status register, the Power Down flag, PDF, will be set and the Watchdog time-out flag, TO,
will be cleared.
Entering the IDLE0 Mode
There is only one way for the device to enter the IDLE0 Mode and that is to execute the “HALT”
instruction in the application program with the IDLEN bit in SMOD register equal to “1” and the
FSYSON bit in SMOD1 register equal to “0”. When this instruction is executed under the conditions
described above, the following will occur:
• The system clock will be stopped and the application program will stop at the “HALT”
instruction, but the fSUB clock will be on.
• The Data Memory contents and registers will maintain their present condition.
• The WDT will be cleared and resume counting as the WDT clock source is derived from the fSUB
clock.
• The I/O ports will maintain their present conditions.
• In the status register, the Power Down flag, PDF, will be set and the Watchdog time-out flag, TO,
will be cleared.
Rev. 1.00
65
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Entering the IDLE1 Mode
There is only one way for the device to enter the IDLE1 Mode and that is to execute the “HALT”
instruction in the application program with the IDLEN bit in SMOD register equal to “1” and the
FSYSON bit in SMOD1 register equal to “1”. When this instruction is executed under the conditions
described above, the following will occur:
• The system clock and fSUB clock will be on and the application program will stop at the “HALT”
instruction.
• The Data Memory contents and registers will maintain their present condition.
• The WDT will be cleared and resume counting as the WDT clock source is derived from the fSUB
clock.
• The I/O ports will maintain their present conditions.
• In the status register, the Power Down flag, PDF, will be set and the Watchdog time-out flag, TO,
will be cleared.
Standby Current Considerations
As the main reason for entering the SLEEP or IDLE Mode is to keep the current consumption of the
device to as low a value as possible, perhaps only in the order of several micro-amps except in the
IDLE1 Mode, there are other considerations which must also be taken into account by the circuit
designer if the power consumption is to be minimised. Special attention must be made to the I/O pins
on the device. All high-impedance input pins must be connected to either a fixed high or low level as
any floating input pins could create internal oscillations and result in increased current consumption.
This also applies to devices which have different package types, as there may be unbonbed pins.
These must either be setup as outputs or if setup as inputs must have pull-high resistors connected.
Care must also be taken with the loads, which are connected to I/O pins, which are setup as outputs.
These should be placed in a condition in which minimum current is drawn or connected only to
external circuits that do not draw current, such as other CMOS inputs. Also note that additional
standby current will also be required if the configuration options have enabled the LXT or LIRC
oscillator.
In the IDLE1 Mode the system oscillator is on, if the system oscillator is from the high speed system
oscillator, the additional standby current will also be perhaps in the order of several hundred micro-amps.
Rev. 1.00
66
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Wake-up
After the system enters the SLEEP or IDLE Mode, it can be woken up from one of various sources
listed as follows:
• An external reset
• An external falling edge on Port A
• A system interrupt
• A WDT overflow
If the system is woken up by an external reset, the device will experience a full system reset,
however, if the device is woken up by a WDT overflow, a Watchdog Timer reset will be initiated.
Although both of these wake-up methods will initiate a reset operation, the actual source of the
wake-up can be determined by examining the TO and PDF flags. The PDF flag is cleared by a
system power-up or executing the clear Watchdog Timer instructions and is set when executing the
"HALT" instruction. The TO flag is set if a WDT time-out occurs, and causes a wake-up that only
resets the Program Counter and Stack Pointer, the other flags remain in their original status.
Each pin on Port A can be setup using the PAWU register to permit a negative transition on the pin
to wake-up the system. When a Port A pin wake-up occurs, the program will resume execution at
the instruction following the "HALT" instruction. If the system is woken up by an interrupt, then
two possible situations may occur. The first is where the related interrupt is disabled or the interrupt
is enabled but the stack is full, in which case the program will resume execution at the instruction
following the "HALT" instruction. In this situation, the interrupt which woke-up the device will not
be immediately serviced, but will rather be serviced later when the related interrupt is finally enabled
or when a stack level becomes free. The other situation is where the related interrupt is enabled and
the stack is not full, in which case the regular interrupt response takes place. If an interrupt request
flag is set high before entering the SLEEP or IDLE Mode, the wake-up function of the related
interrupt will be disabled.
Programming Considerations
The HXT and LXT oscillators both use the same SST counter. For example, if the system is woken
up from the SLEEP0 Mode and both the HXT and LXT oscillators need to start-up from an off state.
The LXT oscillator uses the SST counter after HXT oscillator has finished its SST period.
• If the device is woken up from the SLEEP0 Mode to the NORMAL Mode, the high speed system
oscillator needs an SST period. The device will execute first instruction after HTO is "1". At
this time, the LXT oscillator may not be stable if fSUB is from LXT oscillator. The same situation
occurs in the power-on state. The LXT oscillator is not ready yet when the first instruction is
executed.
• If the device is woken up from the SLEEP1 Mode to NORMAL Mode, and the system clock
source is from HXT oscillator and FSTEN is “1”, the system clock can be switched to the LXT
or LIRC oscillator after wake up.
• There are peripheral functions, such as WDT, TMs and LCD driver, for which the fSYS is used. If
the system clock source is switched from fH to fSUB, the clock source to the peripheral functions
mentioned above will change accordingly.
• The on/off condition of fSUB and fS depends upon whether the WDT is enabled or disabled as the
WDT clock source is selected from fSUB.
Rev. 1.00
67
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Watchdog Timer
The Watchdog Timer is provided to prevent program malfunctions or sequences from jumping to
unknown locations, due to certain uncontrollable external events such as electrical noise.
Watchdog Timer Clock Source
The Watchdog Timer clock source is provided by the internal clock fS, which is in turn supplied by
the fSUB clock. The fSUB clock can be sourced from either the LXT or LIRC oscillator selected by a
configuration option. The LIRC internal oscillator has an approximate frequency of 32kHz and this
specified internal clock period can vary with VDD, temperature and process variations. The LXT
oscillator is supplied by an external 32.768kHz crystal. The Watchdog Timer source clock is then
subdivided by a ratio of 28 to 218 to give longer timeouts, the actual value being chosen using the
WS2~WS0 bits in the WDTC register.
Watchdog Timer Control Register
A single register, WDTC, controls the required time-out period as well as the enable/disable
operation. This register controls the overall operation of the Watchdog Timer.
WDTC Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
WE4
WE3
WE2
WE1
WE0
WS2
WS1
WS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
Bit 7~3
WE4~WE0: WDT function enable control
If the WDT configuration option is “always enable”:
10101 or 01010: Enabled
Other Values: Reset MCU
If the WDT configuration option is “application program enable”:
10101: Disabled
01010: Enabled
Other Values: Reset MCU
If these bits are changed due to adverse environmental conditions, the microcontroller
will be reset. The reset operation will be activated after 2~3 LIRC clock cycles and the
WRF bit in the CTRL register will be set to 1.
Bit 2~0
WS2~WS0: Select WDT Timeout Period
000: 28/fS
001: 210/fS
010: 212/fS
011: 214/fS
100: 215/fS
101: 216/fS
110: 217/fS
111: 218/fS
These three bits determine the division ratio of the Watchdog Timer source clock,
which in turn determines the timeout period.
68
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
SMOD1 Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
FSYSON
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
LVRF
LRF
WRF
R/W
R/W
POR
0
—
—
—
—
R/W
x
0
0
“x” unknown
Bit 7
FSYSON: fSYS Control in IDLE Mode
Described elsewhere.
Bit 6~3
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 2
LVRF: LVR function reset flag
Described elsewhere.
Bit 1
LRF: LVR Control register software reset flag
Described elsewhere.
bit 0
WRF: WDT Control register software reset flag
0: Not occurred
1: Occurred
This bit is set to 1 by the WDT Control register software reset and cleared by the
application program. Note that this bit can only be cleared to 0 by the application
program.
Watchdog Timer Operation
The Watchdog Timer operates by providing a device reset when its timer overflows. This means
that in the application program and during normal operation the user has to strategically clear the
Watchdog Timer before it overflows to prevent the Watchdog Timer from executing a reset. This is
done using the clear watchdog instructions. If the program malfunctions for whatever reason, jumps
to an unknown location, or enters an endless loop, these clear instructions will not be executed
in the correct manner, in which case the Watchdog Timer will overflow and reset the device. The
Watchdog Timer function is determined using a configuration option. With regard to the Watchdog
Timer enable/disable function, there are also five bits, WE4~WE0, in the WDTC register to offer
the additional enable/disable control and reset control of the Watchdog Timer. If the WDT function
configuration option is determined that the WDT function is always enabled, the WE4~WE0 bits
still have effects on the WDT function. When the WE4~WE0 bits value is equal to 01010B or
10101B, the WDT function is enabled. However, if the WE4~WE0 bits are changed to any other
values except 01010B and 10101B, which is caused by the environmental noise, it will reset the
microcontroller after 2~3 fSUB clock cycles. If the WDT function configuration option is determined
that the WDT function is controlled by the WDTC control register using the application program,
the WE4~WE0 values can determine which mode the WDT operates in. The WDT function will
be disabled when the WE4~WE0 bits are set to a value of 10101B while the WDT function will
be enabled if the WE4~WE0 bits are equal to 01010B. If the WE4~WE0 bits are set to any other
values, other than 01010B and 10101B, it will reset the device after 2~3 fSUB clock cycles. After
power on these bits will have a value of 01010B.
WDT Function Control
Application Program Enabled
Always Enabled
WE4~WE0 Bits
WDT Function
10101B
Disable
01010B
Enable
Any other value
Reset MCU
01010B or 10101B
Enable
Any other value
Reset MCU
Watchdog Timer Enable/Disable Control
Rev. 1.00
69
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Under normal program operation, a Watchdog Timer time-out will initialise a device reset and set
the status bit TO. However, if the system is in the SLEEP or IDLE Mode, when a Watchdog Timer
time-out occurs, the TO bit in the status register will be set and only the Program Counter and Stack
Pointer will be reset. Three methods can be adopted to clear the contents of the Watchdog Timer.
The first is a WDT reset, which means a certain value except 01010B and 10101B written into the
WE4~WE0 field, the second is using the Watchdog Timer software clear instruction and the third is
via a HALT instruction.
There is only one method of using software instruction to clear the Watchdog Timer. That is to use
the single “CLR WDT” instruction to clear the WDT contents.
The maximum time out period is when the 218 division ratio is selected. As an example, with a
32kHz LIRC oscillator as its source clock, this will give a maximum watchdog period of around 8
second for the 218 division ratio, and a minimum timeout of 7.8ms for the 28 division ration.
WDTC Register
Reset MCU
WE4~WE0 bits
CLR
“CLR WDT”Instruction
LXT
LIRC
M
U
X
fSUB
Low Speed Oscillator
Configuration option
fS
8-stage Divider
fS/28
WS2~WS0
(fS/28 ~ fS/218)
WDT Prescaler
8-to-1 MUX
WDT Time-out
(28/fS ~ 218/fS)
Watchdog Timer
Reset and Initialisation
A reset function is a fundamental part of any microcontroller ensuring that the device can be set
to some predetermined condition irrespective of outside parameters. The most important reset
condition is after power is first applied to the microcontroller. In this case, internal circuitry will
ensure that the microcontroller, after a short delay, will be in a well defined state and ready to
execute the first program instruction. After this power-on reset, certain important internal registers
will be set to defined states before the program commences. One of these registers is the Program
Counter, which will be reset to zero forcing the microcontroller to begin program execution from the
lowest Program Memory address.
In addition to the power-on reset, situations may arise where it is necessary to forcefully apply a
reset condition when the is running. One example of this is where after power has been applied
and the is already running, the RES line is forcefully pulled low. In such a case, known as a normal
operation reset, some of the registers remain unchanged allowing the to proceed with normal
operation after the reset line is allowed to return high.
Another type of reset is when the Watchdog Timer overflows and resets the . All types of reset
operations result in different register conditions being setup. Another reset exists in the form of a
Low Voltage Reset, LVR, where a full reset, similar to the RES reset is implemented in situations
where the power supply voltage falls below a certain threshold.
Rev. 1.00
70
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Reset Functions
There are five ways in which a reset can occur, through events occurring both internally and
externally:
Power-on Reset
The most fundamental and unavoidable reset is the one that occurs after power is first applied to the.
As well as ensuring that the Program Memory begins execution from the first memory address, a
power-on reset also ensures that certain other registers are preset to known conditions. All the I/O
port and port control registers will power up in a high condition ensuring that all pins will be first set
to inputs.
Power-On Reset Timing Chart
Note: tRSTD is power-on delay, typical time=50ms
RES Pin
As the reset pin is shared with an I/O pin, the reset function must be selected using a configuration
option. Although the has an internal RC reset function, if the VDD power supply rise time is not fast
enough or does not stabilise quickly at power-on, the internal reset function may be incapable of
providing proper reset operation. For this reason it is recommended that an external RC network is
connected to the RES pin, whose additional time delay will ensure that the RES pin remains low for
an extended period to allow the power supply to stabilise. During this time delay, normal operation
of the will be inhibited. After the RES line reaches a certain voltage value, the reset delay time
tRSTD is invoked to provide an extra delay time after which the will begin normal operation. The
abbreviation SST in the figures stands for System Start-up Timer.
For most applications a resistor connected between VDD and the RES pin and a capacitor connected
between VSS and the RES pin will provide a suitable external reset circuit. Any wiring connected to
the RES pin should be kept as short as possible to minimise any stray noise interference.
For applications that operate within an environment where more noise is present the Enhanced Reset
Circuit shown is recommended.
External RES Circuit
Note: * It is recommended that this component is added for added ESD protection.
** It is recommended that this component is added in environments where
power line noise is significant.
Rev. 1.00
71
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
More information regarding external reset circuits is located in Application Note HA0075E on the
Holtek website.
Pulling the RES Pin low using external hardware will also execute a device reset. In this case, as in
the case of other resets, the Program Counter will reset to zero and program execution initiated from
this point.
RES Reset Timing Chart
Note: tRSTD is power-on delay, typical time=16.7ms
Low Voltage Reset – LVR
The microcontroller contains a low voltage reset circuit in order to monitor the supply voltage of the
device. The LVR function is always enabled with a specific LVR voltage, VLVR. If the supply voltage
of the device drops to within a range of 0.9V~VLVR such as might occur when changing the battery,
the LVR will automatically reset the device internally and the LVRF bit in the SMOD1 register will
also be set to 1. For a valid LVR signal, a low supply voltage, i.e., a voltage in the range between
0.9V~VLVR must exist for a time greater than that specified by tLVR in the A.C. characteristics. If the
low supply voltage state does not exceed this value, the LVR will ignore the low supply voltage and
will not perform a reset function. The actual VLVR value can be selected by the LVS bits in the LVRC
register. If the LVS7~LVS0 bits have any other value, which may perhaps occur due to adverse
environmental conditions such as noise, the LVR will reset the device after 2~3 fSUB clock cycles.
When this happens, the LRF bit in the SMOD1 register will be set to 1. After power on the register
will have the value of 01010101B. Note that the LVR function will be automatically disabled when
the device enters the power down mode.
Note: tRSTD is power-on delay, typical time=50ms
Low Voltage Reset Timing Chart
Rev. 1.00
72
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
• LVRC Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
LVS7
LVS6
LVS5
LVS4
LVS3
LVS2
LVS1
LVS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/w
R/w
R/W
R/W
POR
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Bit 7~0
LVS7~LVS0: LVR voltage select
01010101: 2.1V
00110011: 2.55V
10011001: 3.15V
10101010: 3.8V
Any other values: Generates MCU reset – register is reset to POR value
When an actual low voltage condition occurs, as specified by one of the four defined
LVR voltage values above, an MCU reset will be generated. The reset operation will
be activated after 2~3 fSUB clock cycles. In this situation the register contents will
remain the same after such a reset occurs.
Any register value, other than the four defined register values above, will also result in
the generation of an MCU reset. The reset operation will be activated after 2~3 fSUB clock
cycles. However in this situation the register contents will be reset to the POR value.
• SMOD1 Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
FSYSON
—
—
—
—
LVRF
LRF
WRF
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
—
—
—
—
x
0
0
"x" unknown
Bit 7
FSYSON: fSYS Control in IDLE Mode
Described elsewhere.
Bit 6~3
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 2
LVRF: LVR function reset flag
0: Not occurred
1: Occurred
This bit is set to 1 when a specific Low Voltage Reset situation condition occurs. This
bit can only be cleared to 0 by the application program.
Bit 1
LRF: LVR Control register software reset flag
0: Not occurred
1: Occurred
This bit is set to 1 if the LVRC register contains any non defined LVR voltage register
values. This in effect acts like a software-reset function. This bit can only be cleared to
0 by the application program.
bit 0
WRF: WDT Control register software reset flag
Described elsewhere.
Watchdog Time-out Reset during Normal Operation
The Watchdog time-out Reset during normal operation is the same as a hardware RES pin reset
except that the Watchdog time-out flag TO will be set to "1".
WDT Time-out Reset during Normal Operation Timing Chart
Note: tRSTD is power-on delay, typical time=16.7ms
Rev. 1.00
73
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Watchdog Time-out Reset during SLEEP or IDLE Mode
The Watchdog time-out Reset during SLEEP or IDLE Mode is a little different from other kinds
of reset. Most of the conditions remain unchanged except that the Program Counter and the Stack
Pointer will be cleared to "0" and the TO flag will be set to "1". Refer to the A.C. Characteristics for
tSST details.
WDT Time-out Reset during SLEEP or IDLE Timing Chart
Note: The tSST is 15~16 clock cycles if the system clock source is provided by ERC or
HIRC. The tSST is 1024 clock for HXT or LXT. The tSST is 1~2 clock for LIRC.
Reset Initial Conditions
The different types of reset described affect the reset flags in different ways. These flags, known
as PDF and TO are located in the status register and are controlled by various microcontroller
operations, such as the SLEEP or IDLE Mode function or Watchdog Timer. The reset flags are
shown in the table:
TO
PDF
0
0
Power-on reset
RESET Conditions
u
u
RES or LVR reset during NORMAL or SLOW Mode operation
1
u
WDT time-out reset during NORMAL or SLOW Mode operation
1
1
WDT time-out reset during IDLE or SLEEP Mode operation
"u" stands for unchanged
The following table indicates the way in which the various components of the microcontroller are
affected after a power-on reset occurs.
Item
Condition After RESET
Program Counter
Reset to zero
Interrupts
All interrupts will be disabled
WDT, Time Base
Clear after reset, WDT begins counting
Timer Modules
Timer Modules will be turned off
Input/Output Ports
I/O ports will be setup as inputs
Stack Pointer
Stack Pointer will point to the top of the stack
The different kinds of resets all affect the internal registers of the microcontroller in different ways.
To ensure reliable continuation of normal program execution after a reset occurs, it is important to
know what condition the microcontroller is in after a particular reset occurs. The following table
describes how each type of reset affects the microcontroller internal registers.
Rev. 1.00
74
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Register Reset Status Table
HT69F30A
HT69F40A
HT69F50A
Power-on Reset
IAR0
●
●
●
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
MP0
●
●
●
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
IAR1
●
●
●
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
MP1
●
●
●
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
BP
●
---- ---0
---- ---0
---- ---0
---- ---u
Register
BP
RES or LVR Reset
WDT Time-out
(Normal Operation)
WDT Time-out
(HALT)
●
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
ACC
●
●
●
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PCL
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
TBLP
●
●
●
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TBLH
●
●
●
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TBHP
●
---- -xxx
---- -uuu
---- -uuu
---- -uuu
---- xxxx
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
TBHP
●
TBHP
●
---x xxxx
---u uuuu
---u uuuu
---u uuuu
STATUS
●
●
●
--00 xxxx
--uu uuuu
--1u uuuu
- - 11 u u u u
SMOD
●
●
●
0 0 0 0 0 0 11
0 0 0 0 0 0 11
0 0 0 0 0 0 11
uuuu uuuu
LVDC
●
●
●
--00 -000
--00 -000
--00 -000
--uu -uuu
INTEG
●
●
●
--00 0000
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
WDTC
●
●
●
0 1 0 1 0 0 11
0 1 0 1 0 0 11
0 1 0 1 0 0 11
uuuu uuuu
TBC
●
●
●
0 0 11 0 111
0 0 11 0 111
0 0 11 0 111
uuuu uuuu
INTC0
●
●
●
-000 0000
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
INTC1
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SMOD1
●
●
●
0--- -x00
0--- -1uu
0--- -uuu
u--- -uuu
LVRC
●
●
●
0101 0101
uuuu uuuu
0101 0101
uuuu uuuu
MFI0
●
--00 --00
--00 --00
--00 --00
--uu --uu
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
MFI0
MFI1
●
●
●
-000 -000
-000 -000
-000 -000
-uuu -uuu
MFI2
●
●
●
--00 --00
--00 --00
--00 --00
--uu --uu
PAWU
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PAPU
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PA
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PAC
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PBPU
●
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
- - - - 1111
- - - - 1111
- - - - 1111
---- uuuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
- - - - 1111
- - - - 1111
- - - - 1111
---- uuuu
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
---- -000
---- -000
---- -000
---- -uuu
-000 0000
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
PBPU
PB
●
PB
PBC
●
PCPU
Rev. 1.00
●
●
PBC
PCPU
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
75
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
HT69F40A
●
●
●
●
- 111 1111
- 111 1111
- 111 1111
-uuu uuuu
PDPU
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PD
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PDC
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PEPU
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PE
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PEC
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PFPU
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PF
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PFC
●
PC
PC
PCC
HT69F50A
HT69F30A
●
Register
●
PCC
Power-on Reset
RES or LVR Reset
WDT Time-out
(Normal Operation)
WDT Time-out
(HALT)
- - - - - 111
- - - - - 111
- - - - - 111
---- -uuu
- 111 1111
- 111 1111
- 111 1111
-uuu uuuu
- - - - - 111
- - - - - 111
- - - - - 111
---- -uuu
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PGPU
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PG
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PGC
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PHPU
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PH
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PHC
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
●
●
-00- 0-0-
-00- 0-0-
-00- 0-0-
-uu- u-u-
●
●
0000 ----
0000 ----
0000 ----
uuuu ----
PAFS
●
PBFS
PCFS
●
●
●
---- -000
---- -000
---- -000
---- -uuu
PDFS
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PEFS
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PFFS
●
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
●
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
●
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
-000 ----
-000 ----
-000 ----
-uuu ----
PGFS
PHFS
SFS
●
SFS
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM0C0
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM0C1
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM0DL
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM0DH
●
●
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
TM0AL
●
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM0AH
●
●
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
EEC
●
●
●
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
EEA
●
--00 0000
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
-000 0000
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
EEA
●
EED
●
TM1C0
●
Rev. 1.00
●
●
76
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
HT69F50A
HT69F40A
HT69F30A
Register
Power-on Reset
RES or LVR Reset
WDT Time-out
(Normal Operation)
WDT Time-out
(HALT)
TM1C1
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM1DL
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM1DH
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
TM1AL
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM1AH
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
TM1C0
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM1C1
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM1C2
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM1DL
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM1DH
●
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
TM1AL
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM1AH
●
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
TM1BL
●
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM1BH
●
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
TM2C0
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM2C1
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM2DL
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM2DH
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
TM2AL
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM2AH
●
---- --00
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
TM2C0
●
0000 0---
0000 0---
0000 0---
uuuu u---
TM2C1
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM2DL
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM2DH
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM2AL
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM2AH
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TM2RP
●
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
●
0-0- 0000
0-0- 0000
0-0- 0000
u-u- uuuu
LCDC
●
●
Note: “-” not implement
“u” means “unchanged”
“x” means “unknown”
Rev. 1.00
77
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Input/Output Ports
Holtek microcontrollers offer considerable flexibility on their I/O ports. With the input or output
designation of every pin fully under user program control, pull-high selections for all ports and
wake-up selections on certain pins, the user is provided with an I/O structure to meet the needs of a
wide range of application possibilities.
The device provides bidirectional input/output lines labeled with port names PA~PH. These I/O
ports are mapped to the RAM Data Memory with specific addresses as shown in the Special Purpose
Data Memory table. All of these I/O ports can be used for input and output operations. For input
operation, these ports are non-latching, which means the inputs must be ready at the T2 rising edge
of instruction “MOV A, [m]”, where m denotes the port address. For output operation, all the data is
latched and remains unchanged until the output latch is rewritten.
I/O Port Register List
HT69F30A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
Register
Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAWU
PAWU7
PAWU6
PAWU5
PAWU4
PAWU3
PAWU2
PAWU1
PAWU0
PAPU
PAPU7
PAPU6
PAPU5
PAPU4
PAPU3
PAPU2
PAPU1
PAPU0
PA
PA7
PA6
PA5
PA4
PA3
PA2
PA1
PA0
PAC
PAC7
PAC6
PAC5
PAC4
PAC3
PAC2
PAC1
PAC0
PBPU
—
—
—
—
PBPU3
PBPU2
PBPU1
PBPU0
PB
—
—
—
—
PB3
PB2
PB1
PB0
PBC
—
—
—
—
PBC3
PBC2
PBC1
PBC0
PCPU
—
—
—
—
—
PCPU2
PCPU1
PCPU0
PC
—
—
—
—
—
PC2
PC1
PC0
PCC
—
—
—
—
—
PCC2
PCC1
PCC0
PDPU
PDPU7
PDPU6
PDPU5
PDPU4
PDPU3
PDPU2
PDPU1
PDPU0
PD
PD7
PD6
PD5
PD4
PD3
PD2
PD1
PD0
PDC
PDC7
PDC6
PDC5
PDC4
PDC3
PDC2
PDC1
PDC0
PEPU
PEPU7
PEPU6
PEPU5
PEPU4
PEPU3
PEPU2
PEPU1
PEPU0
PE
PE7
PE6
PE5
PE4
PE3
PE2
PE1
PE0
PEC
PEC7
PEC6
PEC5
PEC4
PEC3
PEC2
PEC1
PEC0
PFPU
PFPU7
PFPU6
PFPU5
PFPU4
PFPU3
PFPU2
PFPU1
PFPU0
PF
PF7
PF6
PF5
PF4
PF3
PF2
PF1
PF0
PFC
PFC7
PFC6
PFC5
PFC4
PFC3
PFC2
PFC1
PFC0
78
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
HT69F40A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
Register
Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAWU
PAWU7
PAWU6
PAWU5
PAWU4
PAWU3
PAWU2
PAWU1
PAWU0
PAPU
PAPU7
PAPU6
PAPU5
PAPU4
PAPU3
PAPU2
PAPU1
PAPU0
PA
PA7
PA6
PA5
PA4
PA3
PA2
PA1
PA0
PAC
PAC7
PAC6
PAC5
PAC4
PAC3
PAC2
PAC1
PAC0
PBPU
PBPU7
PBPU6
PBPU5
PBPU4
PBPU3
PBPU2
PBPU1
PBPU0
PB
PB7
PB6
PB5
PB4
PB3
PB2
PB1
PB0
PBC
PBC7
PBC6
PBC5
PBC4
PBC3
PBC2
PBC1
PBC0
PCPU
—
PCPU6
PCPU5
PCPU4
PCPU3
PCPU2
PCPU1
PCPU0
PC
—
PC6
PC5
PC4
PC3
PC2
PC1
PC0
PCC
—
PCC6
PCC4
PCC4
PCC3
PCC2
PCC1
PCC0
PDPU
PDPU7
PDPU6
PDPU5
PDPU4
PDPU3
PDPU2
PDPU1
PDPU0
PD
PD7
PD6
PD5
PD4
PD3
PD2
PD1
PD0
PDC
PDC7
PDC6
PDC5
PDC4
PDC3
PDC2
PDC1
PDC0
PEPU
PEPU7
PEPU6
PEPU5
PEPU4
PEPU3
PEPU2
PEPU1
PEPU0
PE
PE7
PE6
PE5
PE4
PE3
PE2
PE1
PE0
PEC
PEC7
PEC6
PEC5
PEC4
PEC3
PEC2
PEC1
PEC0
PFPU
PFPU7
PFPU6
PFPU5
PFPU4
PFPU3
PFPU2
PFPU1
PFPU0
PF
PF7
PF6
PF5
PF4
PF3
PF2
PF1
PF0
PFC
PFC7
PFC6
PFC5
PFC4
PFC3
PFC2
PFC1
PFC0
PGPU
PGPU7
PGPU6
PGPU5
PGPU4
PGPU3
PGPU2
PGPU1
PGPU0
PG
PG7
PG6
PG5
PG4
PG3
PG2
PG1
PG0
PGC
PGC7
PGC6
PGC5
PGC4
PGC3
PGC2
PGC1
PGC0
79
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
HT69F50A
Bit
Register
Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAWU
PAWU7
PAWU6
PAWU5
PAWU4
PAWU3
PAWU2
PAWU1
PAWU0
PAPU
PAPU7
PAPU6
PAPU5
PAPU4
PAPU3
PAPU2
PAPU1
PAPU0
PA
PA7
PA6
PA5
PA4
PA3
PA2
PA1
PA0
PAC
PAC7
PAC6
PAC5
PAC4
PAC3
PAC2
PAC1
PAC0
PBPU
PBPU7
PBPU6
PBPU5
PBPU4
PBPU3
PBPU2
PBPU1
PBPU0
PB
PB7
PB6
PB5
PB4
PB3
PB2
PB1
PB0
PBC
PBC7
PBC6
PBC5
PBC4
PBC3
PBC2
PBC1
PBC0
PCPU
—
PCPU6
PCPU5
PCPU4
PCPU3
PCPU2
PCPU1
PCPU0
PC
—
PC6
PC5
PC4
PC3
PC2
PC1
PC0
PCC
—
PCC6
PCC4
PCC4
PCC3
PCC2
PCC1
PCC0
PDPU
PDPU7
PDPU6
PDPU5
PDPU4
PDPU3
PDPU2
PDPU1
PDPU0
PD
PD7
PD6
PD5
PD4
PD3
PD2
PD1
PD0
PDC
PDC7
PDC6
PDC5
PDC4
PDC3
PDC2
PDC1
PDC0
PEPU
PEPU7
PEPU6
PEPU5
PEPU4
PEPU3
PEPU2
PEPU1
PEPU0
PE
PE7
PE6
PE5
PE4
PE3
PE2
PE1
PE0
PEC
PEC7
PEC6
PEC5
PEC4
PEC3
PEC2
PEC1
PEC0
PFPU
PFPU7
PFPU6
PFPU5
PFPU4
PFPU3
PFPU2
PFPU1
PFPU0
PF
PF7
PF6
PF5
PF4
PF3
PF2
PF1
PF0
PFC
PFC7
PFC6
PFC5
PFC4
PFC3
PFC2
PFC1
PFC0
PGPU
PGPU7
PGPU6
PGPU5
PGPU4
PGPU3
PGPU2
PGPU1
PGPU0
PG
PG7
PG6
PG5
PG4
PG3
PG2
PG1
PG0
PGC
PGC7
PGC6
PGC5
PGC4
PGC3
PGC2
PGC1
PGC0
PHPU
PHPU7
PHPU6
PHPU5
PHPU4
PHPU3
PHPU2
PHPU1
PHPU0
PH
PH7
PH6
PH5
PH4
PH3
PH2
PH1
PH0
PHC
PHC7
PHC6
PHC5
PHC4
PHC3
PHC2
PHC1
PHC0
“—” Unimplemented, read as “0”
PAWUn: PA wake-up function control
0: Disable
1: Enable
PAn/PBn/PCn/PDn/PEn/PFn/PGn/PHn: I/O Data bit
0: Data 0
1: Data 1
PACn/PBCn/PCCn/PDCn/PECn/PFCn/PGCn/PHCn: I/O type selection
0: Output
1: Input
PAPUn/PBPUn/PCPUn/PDPUn/PEPUn/PFPUn/PGPUn/PHPUn: Pull-high function control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Rev. 1.00
80
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Pull-high Resistors
Many product applications require pull-high resistors for their switch inputs usually requiring the
use of an external resistor. To eliminate the need for these external resistors, all I/O pins, when
configured as an input have the capability of being connected to an internal pull-high resistor. These
pull-high resistors are selected using registers PAPU~PHPU, and are implemented using weak
PMOS transistors.
Port A Wake-up
The HALT instruction forces the microcontroller into the SLEEP or IDLE Mode which preserves
power, a feature that is important for battery and other low-power applications. Various methods
exist to wake-up the microcontroller, one of which is to change the logic condition on one of the Port
A pins from high to low. This function is especially suitable for applications that can be woken up
via external switches. Each pin on Port A can be selected individually to have this wake-up feature
using the PAWU register.
I/O Port Control Registers
Each Port has its own control register, known as PAC~PHC, which controls the input/output
configuration. With this control register, each I/O pin with or without pull-high resistors can be
reconfigured dynamically under software control. For the I/O pin to function as an input, the
corresponding bit of the control register must be written as a “1”. This will then allow the logic state
of the input pin to be directly read by instructions. When the corresponding bit of the control register
is written as a “0”, the I/O pin will be setup as a CMOS output. If the pin is currently setup as an
output, instructions can still be used to read the output register.
However, it should be noted that the program will in fact only read the status of the output data latch
and not the actual logic status of the output pin.
Pin-shared Functions
The flexibility of the microcontroller range is greatly enhanced by the use of pins that have more
than one function. Limited numbers of pins can force serious design constraints on designers but by
supplying pins with multi-functions, many of these difficulties can be overcome. For these pins, the
chosen function of the multi-function I/O pins is selected by a series of regiters via the application
program control.
Rev. 1.00
81
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Pin-shared Function Selection Register List
• HT69F30A
Bit
Register
Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAFS
—
PAFS6
PAFS5
—
PAFS3
—
PAFS1
—
PCFS
—
—
—
—
—
PCFS2
PCFS1
PCFS0
PDFS
PDFS7
PDFS6
PDFS5
PDFS4
PDFS3
PDFS2
PDFS1
PDFS0
PEFS
PEFS7
PEFS6
PEFS5
PEFS4
PEFS3
PEFS2
PEFS1
PEFS0
PFFS
PFFS7
PFFS6
PFFS5
PFFS4
PFFS3
PFFS2
PFFS1
PFFS0
SFS
—
SFS6
SFS5
SFS4
—
—
—
—
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
• HT69F40A
Register
Name
Bit
PAFS
—
PAFS6
PAFS5
—
PAFS3
—
PAFS1
PBFS
PBFS7
PBFS6
PBFS5
PBFS4
—
—
—
—
PCFS
—
—
—
—
—
PCFS2
PCFS1
PCFS0
PDFS
PDFS7
PDFS6
PDFS5
PDFS4
PDFS3
PDFS2
PDFS1
PDFS0
PEFS
PEFS7
PEFS6
PEFS5
PEFS4
PEFS3
PEFS2
PEFS1
PEFS0
PFFS
PFFS7
PFFS6
PFFS5
PFFS4
PFFS3
PFFS2
PFFS1
PFFS0
PGFS
PGS7
PFGFS6
PGFS5
PGFS4
PGFS3
PGFS2
PGFS1
PGFS0
SFS
SFS7
SFS6
SFS5
SFS4
SFS3
SFS2
SFS1
SFS0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
• HT69F50A
Register
Name
Rev. 1.00
Bit
PAFS
—
PAFS6
PAFS5
—
PAFS3
—
PAFS1
PBFS
PBFS7
PBFS6
PBFS5
PBFS4
—
—
—
—
PCFS
—
—
—
—
—
PCFS2
PCFS1
PCFS0
PDFS
PDFS7
PDFS6
PDFS5
PDFS4
PDFS3
PDFS2
PDFS1
PDFS0
PEFS
PEFS7
PEFS6
PEFS5
PEFS4
PEFS3
PEFS2
PEFS1
PEFS0
PFFS
PFFS7
PFFS6
PFFS5
PFFS4
PFFS3
PFFS2
PFFS1
PFFS0
PGFS
PGS7
PGFS6
PGFS5
PGFS4
PGFS3
PGFS2
PGFS1
PGFS0
PHFS
PHS7
PHFS6
PHFS5
PHFS4
PHFS3
PHFS2
PHFS1
PHFS0
SFS
SFS7
SFS6
SFS5
SFS4
SFS3
SFS2
SFS1
SFS0
82
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PAFS Register – HT69F30A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
PAFS6
PAFS5
—
PAFS3
—
PAFS1
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
—
R/W
—
POR
—
0
0
—
0
—
0
—
Bit 7
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 6
PAFS6: Port A 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP0_0
Bit 5
PAFS5: Port A 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1_1
Bit 4
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 3
PAFS3: Port A 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1_0
Bit 2
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 1
PAFS1: Port A 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP0_1
Bit 0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
PAFS Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
PAFS6
PAFS5
—
PAFS3
—
PAFS1
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
—
R/W
—
POR
—
0
0
—
0
—
0
—
Bit 7
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 6
PAFS6: Port A 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP0_0
Bit 5
PAFS5: Port A 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP2_1
Bit 4
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 3
PAFS3: Port A 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP2_0
Bit 2
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 1
PAFS1: Port A 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP0_1
Bit 0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
83
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PBFS Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PBFS7
PBFS6
PBFS5
PBFS4
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
POR
0
0
0
0
—
—
—
—
Bit 7
PBFS7: Port B 7 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1B_2
Bit 6
PBFS6: Port B 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1B_1
Bit 5
PBFS5: Port B 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1B_0
Bit 4
PBFS4: Port B 4 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1A
Bit 3~0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
PCFS Register – HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
—
PCFS2
PCFS1
PCFS0
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
0
Bit 7~3
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 2
PCFS2: Port C 2 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: C2
Bit 1
PCFS1: Port C 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: C1
Bit 0
PCFS0: Port C 0 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: V2
84
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PDFS Register – HT69F30A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PDFS7
PDFS6
PDFS5
PDFS4
PDFS3
PDFS2
PDFS1
PDFS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
PDFS7: Port D 7 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG7
Bit 6
PDFS6: Port D 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG6
Bit 5
PDFS5: Port D 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG5
Bit 4
PDFS4: Port D 4 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG4
Bit 3
PDFS3: Port D 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG3
Bit 2
PDFS2: Port D 2 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG2
Bit 1
PDFS1: Port D 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG1
Bit 0
PDFS0: Port D 0 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG0
85
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PDFS Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PDFS7
PDFS6
PDFS5
PDFS4
PDFS3
PDFS2
PDFS1
PDFS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
PDFS7: Port D 7 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG7 or TP1B_2
Bit 6
PDFS6: Port D 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG6 or TP1B_1
Bit 5
PDFS5: Port D 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG5 or TP1B_0
Bit 4
PDFS4: Port D 4 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG4 or TP1A
Bit 3
PDFS3: Port D 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG3
Bit 2
PDFS2: Port D 2 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG2
Bit 1
PDFS1: Port D 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG1
Bit 0
PDFS0: Port D 0 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG0
86
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PEFS Register – HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PEFS7
PEFS6
PEFS5
PEFS4
PEFS3
PEFS2
PEFS1
PEFS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
PEFS7: Port E 7 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG15
Bit 6
PEFS6: Port E 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG14
Bit 5
PEFS5: Port E 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG13
Bit 4
PEFS4: Port E 4 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG12
Bit 3
PEFS3: Port E 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG11
Bit 2
PEFS2: Port E 2 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG10
Bit 1
PEFS1: Port E 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG9
Bit 0
PEFS0: Port E 0 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG8
87
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PFFS Register – HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PFFS7
PFFS6
PFFS5
PFFS4
PFFS3
PFFS2
PFFS1
PFFS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
PFFS7: Port F 7 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG23
Bit 6
PFFS6: Port F 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG22
Bit 5
PFFS5: Port F 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG21
Bit 4
PFFS4: Port F 4 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG20
Bit 3
PFFS3: Port F 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG19
Bit 2
PFFS2: Port F 2 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG18
Bit 1
PFFS1: Port F 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG17
Bit 0
PFFS0: Port F 0 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG16
88
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PGFS Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PGFS7
PGFS6
PGFS5
PGFS4
PGFS3
PGFS2
PGFS1
PGFS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
PGFS7: Port G 7 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG31
Bit 6
PGFS6: Port G 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG30
Bit 5
PGFS5: Port G 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG29
Bit 4
PGFS4: Port G 4 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG28
Bit 3
PGFS3: Port G 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG27
Bit 2
PGFS2: Port G 2 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG26
Bit 1
PGFS1: Port G 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG25
Bit 0
PGFS0: Port G 0 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG24
89
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PHFS Register – HT69F50A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PHFS7
PHFS6
PHFS5
PHFS4
PHFS3
PHFS2
PHFS1
PHFS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
PHFS7: Port H 7 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG39
Bit 6
PHFS6: Port H 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG38
Bit 5
PHFS5: Port H 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG37
Bit 4
PHFS4: Port H 4 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG36
Bit 3
PHFS3: Port H 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG35
Bit 2
PHFS2: Port H 2 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG34
Bit 1
PHFS1: Port H 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG33
Bit 0
PHFS0: Port H 0 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG32
SFS Register – HT69F30A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
SFS6
SFS5
SFS4
—
—
—
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
POR
—
0
0
0
—
—
—
—
Bit 7
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 6
SFS6: TCK1 Source Selection
0: PA2
1: PD2
Bit 5
SFS5: TCK0 Source Selection
0: PA2
1: PD1
Bit 4
SFS4: INT1 Source Selection
0: PA0
1: PD0
Bit 3~0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
90
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
SFS Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
SFS7
SFS6
SFS5
SFS4
SFS3
SFS2
SFS1
SFS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
SFS7: TCK2 Source Selection
0: PA2
1: PD2
Bit 6
SFS6: TCK1 Source Selection
0: PA0
1: PD3
Bit 5
SFS5: TCK0 Source Selection
0: PA2
1: PD1
Bit 4
SFS4: INT1 Source Selection
0: PA0
1: PD0
Bit 3
SFS3: PD7 Special Function Selection
0: SEG7
1: TP1B_2
Bit 2
SFS2: PD6 Special Function Selection
0: SEG6
1: TP1B_1
Bit 1
SFS1: PD5 Special Function Selection
0: SEG5
1: TP1B_0
Bit 0
SFS0: PD4 Special Function Selection
0: SEG4
1: TP1A
91
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
I/O Pin Structures
The accompanying diagrams illustrate the internal structures of some generic I/O pin types. As
the exact logical construction of the I/O pin will differ from these drawings, they are supplied as a
guide only to assist with the functional understanding of the I/O pins. The wide range of pin-shared
structures does not permit all types to be shown.
Programming Considerations
Within the user program, one of the things first to consider is port initialisation. After a reset, all
of the I/O data and port control registers will be set to high. This means that all I/O pins will be
defaulted to an input state, the level of which depends on the other connected circuitry and whether
pull-high selections have been chosen. If the port control registers are then programmed to setup
some pins as outputs, these output pins will have an initial high output value unless the associated
port data registers are first programmed. Selecting which pins are inputs and which are outputs can
be achieved byte-wide by loading the correct values into the appropriate port control register or
by programming individual bits in the port control register using the “SET [m].i” and “CLR [m].i”
instructions. Note that when using these bit control instructions, a read-modify-write operation takes
place. The microcontroller must first read in the data on the entire port, modify it to the required new
bit values and then rewrite this data back to the output ports.
Port A has the additional capability of providing wake-up functions. When the device is in the
SLEEP or IDLE Mode, various methods are available to wake the device up. One of these is a high
to low transition of any of the Port A pins. Single or multiple pins on Port A can be setup to have this
function.
    
  Generic Input/Output Structure
Rev. 1.00
92
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Timer Modules – TM
One of the most fundamental functions in any microcontroller device is the ability to control and
measure time. To implement time related functions each device includes several Timer Modules,
abbreviated to the name TM. The TMs are multi-purpose timing units and serve to provide
operations such as Timer/Counter, Input Capture, Compare Match Output and Single Pulse Output
as well as being the functional unit for the generation of PWM signals. Each of the TMs has either
two or three individual interrupts. The addition of input and output pins for each TM ensures that
users are provided with timing units with a wide and flexible range of features.
The common features of the different TM types are described here with more detailed information
provided in the individual Compact, Standard and Enhanced TM sections.
Introduction
The devices contain from two to three TMs depending upon which device is selected with each
TM having a reference name of TM0, TM1, and TM2. Each individual TM can be categorised as
a certain type, namely Compact Type TM, Standard Type TM or Enhanced Type TM. Although
similar in nature, the different TM types vary in their feature complexity. The common features
to all of the Compact, Standard and Enhanced TMs will be described in this section, the detailed
operation regarding each of the TM types will be described in separate sections. The main features
and differences between the three types of TMs are summarised in the accompanying table.
TM Function
CTM
STM
ETM
Timer/Counter
√
√
√
I/P Capture
—
√
√
Compare Match Output
√
√
√
PWM Channels
1
1
2
Single Pulse Output
—
1
2
Edge
Edge
Edge & Centre
Duty or Period
Duty or Period
Duty or Period
PWM Alignment
PWM Adjustment Period & Duty
TM Function Summary
Each device in the series contains a specific number of either Compact Type, Standard Type and
Enhanced Type TM unit which are shown in the table together with their individual reference name,
TM0~TM2.
Device
TM0
TM1
HT69F30A
10-bit CTM
10-bit STM
TM2
—
HT69F40A
10-bit CTM
10-bit ETM
10-bit STM
HT69F50A
10-bit CTM
10-bit ETM
16-bit STM
TM Name/Type Reference
TM Operation
The three different types of TM offer a diverse range of functions, from simple timing operations
to PWM signal generation. The key to understanding how the TM operates is to see it in terms of
a free running counter whose value is then compared with the value of pre-programmed internal
comparators. When the free running counter has the same value as the pre-programmed comparator,
known as a compare match situation, a TM interrupt signal will be generated which can clear the
counter and perhaps also change the condition of the TM output pin. The internal TM counter is
driven by a user selectable clock source, which can be an internal clock or an external pin.
Rev. 1.00
93
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TM Clock Source
The clock source which drives the main counter in each TM can originate from various sources. The
selection of the required clock source is implemented using the TnCK2~TnCK0 bits in the TMn
control registers. The clock source can be a ratio of either the system clock fSYS or the internal high
clock fH, the fSUB clock source or the external TCKn pin. Note that setting these bits to the value 101
will select a reserved clock input, in effect disconnecting the TM clock source. The TCKn pin clock
source is used to allow an external signal to drive the TM as an external clock source or for event
counting.
TM Interrupts
The Compact and Standard type TMs each have two internal interrupts, one for each of the internal
comparator A or comparator P, which generate a TM interrupt when a compare match condition
occurs. As the Enhanced type TM has three internal comparators and comparator A or comparator
B or comparator P compare match functions, it consequently has three internal interrupts. When a
TM interrupt is generated it can be used to clear the counter and also to change the state of the TM
output pin.
TM External Pins
Each of the TMs, irrespective of what type, has one TM input pin, with the label TCKn. The TM
input pin, is essentially a clock source for the TM and is selected using the TnCK2~TnCK0 bits in
the TMnC0 register. This external TM input pin allows an external clock source to drive the internal
TM. This external TM input pin is shared with other functions but will be connected to the internal
TM if selected using the TnCK2~TnCK0 bits. The TM input pin can be chosen to have either a
rising or falling active edge.
The TMs each have one or more output pins with the label TPn. When the TM is in the Compare
Match Output Mode, these pins can be controlled by the TM to switch to a high or low level or to
toggle when a compare match situation occurs. The external TPn output pin is also the pin where
the TM generates the PWM output waveform. As the TM output pins are pin-shared with other
function, the TM output function must first be setup using registers. A single bit in one of the
registers determines if its associated pin is to be used as an external TM output pin or if it is to have
another function. The number of output pins for each TM type and device is different, the details are
provided in the accompanying table.
All TM output pin names have a “_n” suffix. Pin names that include a “_1” or “_2” suffix indicate
that they are from a TM with multiple output pins. This allows the TM to generate a complimentary
output pair, selected using the I/O register data bits.
Device
CTM
STM
ETM
HT69F30A
TP0_0,TP0_1
TP1_0,TP1_1
—
Registers
HT69F40A
TP0_0,TP0_1
TP2_0,TP2_1
TP1A,
TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TP1B_2
PAFS, PBFS, PDFS
HT69F50A
TP0_0,TP0_1
TP2_0,TP2_1
TP1A,
TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TP1B_2
PAFS, PBFS, PDFS
PAFS
TM Output Pins
Rev. 1.00
94
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TM Input/Output Pin Control Registers
Selecting to have a TM input/output or whether to retain its other shared function, is implemented
using one or two registers, with a single bit in each register corresponding to a TM input/output pin.
Setting the bit high will setup the corresponding pin as a TM input/output, if reset to zero the pin
will retain its original other function.
TM Input/Output Pin Control Register List
• HT69F30A
Bit
Register
Name
7
6
5
PAFS
—
PAFS6
SFS
—
SFS6
4
3
2
1
0
PAFS5
—
PAFS3
—
PAFS1
—
SFS5
SFS4
—
—
—
—
• HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Bit
Register
Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAFS
—
PAFS6
PAFS5
—
PAFS3
—
PAFS1
—
PBFS
PBFS7
PBFS6
PBFS5
PBFS4
—
—
—
—
PDFS
PDFS7
PDFS6
PDFS5
PDFS4
PDFS3
PDFS2
PDFS1
PDFS0
SFS
SFS7
SFS6
SFS5
SFS4
SFS3
SFS2
SFS1
SFS0
PAFS Register – HT69F30A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
PAFS6
PAFS5
—
PAFS3
—
PAFS1
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
—
R/W
—
POR
—
0
0
—
0
—
0
—
Bit 7
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 6
PAFS6: Port A 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP0_0
Bit 5
PAFS5: Port A 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1_1
Bit 4
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 3
PAFS3: Port A 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1_0
Bit 2
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 1
PAFS1: Port A 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP0_1
Bit 0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
95
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PAFS Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
PAFS6
PAFS5
—
PAFS3
—
PAFS1
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
—
R/W
—
POR
—
0
0
—
0
—
0
—
Bit 7
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 6
PAFS6: Port A 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP0_0
Bit 5
PAFS5: Port A 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP2_1
Bit 4
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 3
PAFS3: Port A 3 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP2_0
Bit 2
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 1
PAFS1: Port A 1 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP0_1
Bit 0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
PBFS Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PBFS7
PBFS6
PBFS5
PBFS4
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
POR
0
0
0
0
—
—
—
—
Bit 7
PBFS7: Port B 7 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1B_2
Bit 6
PBFS6: Port B 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1B_1
Bit 5
PBFS5: Port B 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1B_0
Bit 4
PBFS4: Port B 4 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: TP1A
Bit 3~0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
96
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PDFS Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PDFS7
PDFS6
PDFS5
PDFS4
PDFS3
PDFS2
PDFS1
PDFS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
PDFS7: Port D 7 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG7 or TP1B_2
Bit 6
PDFS6: Port D 6 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG6 or TP1B_1
Bit 5
PDFS5: Port D 5 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG5 or TP1B_0
Bit 4
PDFS4: Port D 4 Function Selection
0: I/O
1: SEG4 or TP1A
Bit 3~0
PDFS3~PDFS0: Port D 3~0 Function Selection
Described elsewhere.
SFS Register – HT69F30A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
SFS6
SFS5
SFS4
—
—
—
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
POR
—
0
0
0
—
—
—
—
Bit 7
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 6
SFS6: TCK1 Source Selection
0: PA2
1: PD2
Bit 5
SFS5: TCK0 Source Selection
0: PA2
1: PD1
Bit 4
SFS4: INT1 Source Selection
Described elsewhere.
Bit 3~0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
97
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
SFS Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
SFS7
SFS6
SFS5
SFS4
SFS3
SFS2
SFS1
SFS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
SFS7: TCK2 Source Selection
0: PA2
1: PD2
Bit 6
SFS6: TCK1 Source Selection
0: PA0
1: PD3
Bit 5
SFS5: TCK0 Source Selection
0: PA2
1: PD1
Bit 4
SFS4: INT1 Source Selection
Described elsewhere.
Bit 3
SFS3: PD7 Special Function Selection
0: SEG7
1: TP1B_2
Bit 2
SFS2: PD6 Special Function Selection
0: SEG6
1: TP1B_1
Bit 1
SFS1: PD5 Special Function Selection
0: SEG5
1: TP1B_0
Bit 0
SFS0: PD4 Special Function Selection
0: SEG4
1: TP1A
98
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PA6
0
0
1
1
PA6/TP0_0
PAFS6
PA6
PA1
Output
0
0
1
PA1/TP0_1
1
TM0
(CTM)
PAFS3
PA1
TCK0 Input
PA2 or PD1/TCK0
CTM Function Pin Control Block Diagram – HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
PA3
0
PA3/TPn_0
1
1
PAFS3
PA3
PA5
Output
0
0
0
PA5/TPn_1
1
1
PAFS5
PA5
1
Capture Input
0
TMn
(STM)
“0”
PAFS5
1
0
“0”
PAFS3
TCKn Input
PA2 or PD2/TCKn
STM Function Pin Control Block Diagram – HT69F30A (n=1); HT69F40A/HT69F50A (n=2)
Rev. 1.00
99
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
PB4, PD4
CCRA Output
0
PB4 or PD4/TP1A
1
PBFS4, PDFS4
1
CCRA Capture Input
0
“0”
PBFS4, PDFS4
PB5, PD5
0
0
1
1
PB5 or PD5/TP1B_0
PBFS5, PDFS5
PB5, PD5
PB6, PD6
0
0
1
PB6 or PD6/TP1B_1
1
PBFS6, PDFS6
TM1
(ETM)
PB6, PD6
CCRB Output
PB7, PD7
0
0
1
PB7 or PD7/TP1B_2
1
PBFS7, PDFS7
PB7, PD7
1
CCRB Capture Input
0
“0”
PBFS7, PDFS7
1
0
“0”
PBFS6, PDFS6
1
0
“0”
PBFS5, PDFS5
TCK1 Input
PA0 or PD3/TCK1
ETM Function Pin Control Block Diagram – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Note: The I/O register data bits shown are used for TM output inversion control. In the Capture
Input Mode, the TM pin control register must never enable more than one TM input.
Rev. 1.00
100
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Programming Considerations
The TM Counter Registers and the Capture/Compare CCRA and CCRB registers, being either 10-bit
or 16-bit, all have a low and high byte structure. The high bytes can be directly accessed, but as
the low bytes can only be accessed via an internal 8-bit buffer, reading or writing to these register
pairs must be carried out in a specific way. The important point to note is that data transfer to and
from the 8-bit buffer and its related low byte only takes place when a write or read operation to its
corresponding high byte is executed.
As the CCRA and CCRB registers are implemented in the way shown in the following diagram and
accessing these register pairs is carried out in a specific way described above, it is recommended to
use the “MOV” instruction to access the CCRA and CCRB low byte registers, named TMxAL and
TMxBL, using the following access procedures. Accessing the CCRA or CCRB low byte registers
without following these access procedures will result in unpredictable values.
T� Counte� Registe� (Read only)
T�xDL
T�xDH
8-bit
Buffe�
T�xAL
T�xAH
T� CCRA Registe� (Read/W�ite)
T�xBL
T�xBH
T� CCRB Registe� (Read/W�ite)
Data
Bus
The following steps show the read and write procedures:
• Writing Data to CCRB or CCRA
♦♦
Step 1. Write data to Low Byte TMxAL or TMxBL
–– Note that here data is only written to the 8-bit buffer.
♦♦
Step 2. Write data to High Byte TMxAH or TMxBH
–– Here data is written directly to the high byte registers and simultaneously data is latched
from the 8-bit buffer to the Low Byte registers.
• Reading Data from the Counter Registers and CCRB or CCRA
Rev. 1.00
♦♦
Step 1. Read data from the High Byte TMxDH, TMxAH or TMxBH
–– Here data is read directly from the High Byte registers and simultaneously data is latched
from the Low Byte register into the 8-bit buffer.
♦♦
Step 2. Read data from the Low Byte TMxDL, TMxAL or TMxBL
–– This step reads data from the 8-bit buffer.
101
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Compact Type TM – CTM
Although the simplest form of the three TM types, the Compact TM type still contains three
operating modes, which are Compare Match Output, Timer/Event Counter and PWM Output modes.
The Compact TM can also be controlled with an external input pin and can drive one or two external
output pins. These two external output pins can be the same signal or the inverse signal.
Device
TM Type
TM Name.
TM Input Pin
TM Output Pin
HT69F30A
HT69F40A
HT69F50A
10-bit CTM
TM0
TCK0
TP0_0, TP0_1
€‚
ƒ ‚ „
€‚ ƒ ‚
€† „ ‡
€† „‡
€‚ ˆ
 ‰  Š  ‹
             
   
   
­
­     Compact Type TM Block Diagram (n=0)
Compact TM Operation
At its core is a 10-bit count-up counter which is driven by a user selectable internal or external clock
source. There are also two internal comparators with the names, Comparator A and Comparator
P. These comparators will compare the value in the counter with CCRP and CCRA registers. The
CCRP is three bits wide whose value is compared with the highest three bits in the counter while the
CCRA is the ten bits and therefore compares with all counter bits.
The only way of changing the value of the 10-bit counter using the application program, is to
clear the counter by changing the TnON bit from low to high. The counter will also be cleared
automatically by a counter overflow or a compare match with one of its associated comparators.
When these conditions occur, a TM interrupt signal will also usually be generated. The Compact
Type TM can operate in a number of different operational modes, can be driven by different clock
sources including an input pin and can also control an output pin. All operating setup conditions are
selected using relevant internal registers.
Rev. 1.00
102
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Compact Type TM Register Description
Overall operation of the Compact TM is controlled using six registers. A read only register pair
exists to store the internal counter 10-bit value, while a read/write register pair exists to store the
internal 10-bit CCRA value. The remaining two registers are control registers which setup the
different operating and control modes as well as the three CCRP bits.
Name
Bit7
Bit6
Bit5
Bit4
Bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
TMnC0
TnPAU
TnCK2
TnCK1
TnCK0
TnON
TnRP2
TnRP1
TnRP0
TMnC1
TnM1
TnM0
TnIO1
TnIO0
TnOC
TnPOL
TnDPX
TnCCLR
TMnDL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TMnDH
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
TMnAL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TMnAH
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
Compact TM Register List (n=0)
TMnDL Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TMnDL: TMn Counter Low Byte Register bit 7 ~ bit 0
TMn 10-bit Counter bit 7 ~ bit 0
TMnDH Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
R
R
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~2
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 1~0
TMnDH: TMn Counter High Byte Register bit 1 ~ bit 0
TMn 10-bit Counter bit 9 ~ bit 8
TMnAL Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TMnAL: TMn CCRA Low Byte Register bit 7 ~ bit 0
TMn 10-bit CCRA bit 7 ~ bit 0
TMnAH Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~2
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 1~0
TMnAH: TMn CCRA High Byte Register bit 1 ~ bit 0
TMn 10-bit CCRA bit 9 ~ bit 8
103
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TMnC0 Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
TnPAU
TnCK2
TnCK1
TnCK0
TnON
TnRP2
TnRP1
TnRP0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
TnPAU: TMn Counter Pause Control
0: Run
1: Pause
The counter can be paused by setting this bit high. Clearing the bit to zero restores
normal counter operation. When in a Pause condition the TM will remain powered up
and continue to consume power. The counter will retain its residual value when this bit
changes from low to high and resume counting from this value when the bit changes
to a low value again.
Bit 6~4
TnCK2~TnCK0: Select TMn Counter clock
000: fSYS/4
001: fSYS
010: fH/16
011: fH/64
100: fSUB
101: Reserved
110: TCKn rising edge clock
111: TCKn falling edge clock
These three bits are used to select the clock source for the TM. Selecting the Reserved
clock input will effectively disable the internal counter. The external pin clock source
can be chosen to be active on the rising or falling edge. The clock source fSYS is the
system clock, while fH and fSUB are other internal clocks, the details of which can be
found in the oscillator section.
Bit 3
TnON: TMn Counter On/Off Control
0: Off
1: On
This bit controls the overall on/off function of the TM. Setting the bit high enables the
counter to run, clearing the bit disables the TM. Clearing this bit to zero will stop the
counter from counting and turn off the TM which will reduce its power consumption.
When the bit changes state from low to high the internal counter value will be reset
to zero, however when the bit changes from high to low, the internal counter will
retain its residual value. If the TM is in the Compare Match Output Mode then the TM
output pin will be reset to its initial condition, as specified by the TnOC bit, when the
TnON bit changes from low to high.
104
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Bit 2~0
TnRP2~TnRP0: TMn CCRP 3-bit register, compared with the TMn Counter bit 9~bit 7
Comparator P Match Period
000: 1024 TMn clocks
001: 128 TMn clocks
010: 256 TMn clocks
011: 384 TMn clocks
100: 512 TMn clocks
101: 640 TMn clocks
110: 768 TMn clocks
111: 896 TMn clocks
These three bits are used to setup the value on the internal CCRP 3-bit register, which
are then compared with the internal counter's highest three bits. The result of this
comparison can be selected to clear the internal counter if the TnCCLR bit is set to
zero. Setting the TnCCLR bit to zero ensures that a compare match with the CCRP
values will reset the internal counter. As the CCRP bits are only compared with the
highest three counter bits, the compare values exist in 128 clock cycle multiples.
Clearing all three bits to zero is in effect allowing the counter to overflow at its
maximum value.
TMnC1 Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
TnM1
TnM0
TnIO1
TnIO0
TnOC
TnPOL
TnDPX
TnCCLR
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~6
TnM1~TnM0: Select TMn Operating Mode
00: Compare Match Output Mode
01: Undefined
10: PWM Mode
11: Timer/Counter Mode
These bits setup the required operating mode for the TM. To ensure reliable operation
the TM should be switched off before any changes are made to the TnM1 and TnM0
bits. In the Timer/Counter Mode, the TM output pin control must be disabled.
Bit 5~4
TnIO1~TnIO0: Select TPn_0, TPn_1 output function
Compare Match Output Mode
00: No change
01: Output low
10: Output high
11: Toggle output
PWM Mode
00: PWM Output inactive state
01: PWM Output active state
10: PWM output
11: Undefined
Timer/counter Mode
unused
These two bits are used to determine how the TM output pin changes state when a
certain condition is reached. The function that these bits select depends upon in which
mode the TM is running.
105
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
In the Compare Match Output Mode, the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits determine how the
TM output pin changes state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A.
The TM output pin can be setup to switch high, switch low or to toggle its present
state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A. When the bits are both
zero, then no change will take place on the output. The initial value of the TM output
pin should be setup using the TnOC bit in the TMnC1 register. Note that the output
level requested by the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits must be different from the initial value
setup using the TnOC bit otherwise no change will occur on the TM output pin when
a compare match occurs. After the TM output pin changes state it can be reset to its
initial level by changing the level of the TnON bit from low to high.
In the PWM Mode, the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits determine how the TM output pin
changes state when a certain compare match condition occurs. The PWM output
function is modified by changing these two bits. It is necessary to only change the
values of the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits only after the TMn has been switched off.
Unpredictable PWM outputs will occur if the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits are changed when
the TM is running.
Bit 3
TnOC: TPn_0, TPn_1 Output control bit
Compare Match Output Mode
0: Initial low
1: Initial high
PWM Mode
0: Active low
1: Active high
This is the output control bit for the TM output pin. Its operation depends upon
whether TM is being used in the Compare Match Output Mode or in the PWM Mode.
It has no effect if the TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode. In the Compare Match Output
Mode it determines the logic level of the TM output pin before a compare match
occurs. In the PWM Mode it determines if the PWM signal is active high or active
low.
Rev. 1.00
Bit 2
TnPOL: TPn_0, TPn_1 Output polarity Control
0: Non-invert
1: Invert
This bit controls the polarity of the TPn_0 or TPn_1 output pin. When the bit is set
high the TM output pin will be inverted and not inverted when the bit is zero. It has no
effect if the TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode.
Bit 1
TnDPX: TMn PWM period/duty Control
0: CCRP - period; CCRA - duty
1: CCRP - duty; CCRA - period
This bit, determines which of the CCRA and CCRP registers are used for period and
duty control of the PWM waveform.
Bit 0
TnCCLR: Select TMn Counter clear condition
0: TMn Comparatror P match
1: TMn Comparatror A match
This bit is used to select the method which clears the counter. Remember that the
Compact TM contains two comparators, Comparator A and Comparator P, either of
which can be selected to clear the internal counter. With the TnCCLR bit set high,
the counter will be cleared when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A.
When the bit is low, the counter will be cleared when a compare match occurs from
the Comparator P or with a counter overflow. A counter overflow clearing method can
only be implemented if the CCRP bits are all cleared to zero. The TnCCLR bit is not
used in the PWM Mode.
106
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Compact Type TM Operating Modes
The Compact Type TM can operate in one of three operating modes, Compare Match Output Mode,
PWM Mode or Timer/Counter Mode. The operating mode is selected using the TnM1 and TnM0
bits in the TMnC1 register.
Compare Match Output Mode
To select this mode, bits TnM1 and TnM0 in the TMnC1 register, should be set to 00 respectively.
In this mode once the counter is enabled and running it can be cleared by three methods. These are
a counter overflow, a compare match from Comparator A and a compare match from Comparator P.
When the TnCCLR bit is low, there are two ways in which the counter can be cleared. One is when
a compare match occurs from Comparator P, the other is when the CCRP bits are all zero which
allows the counter to overflow. Here both TnAF and TnPF interrupt request flags for the Comparator
A and Comparator P respectively, will both be generated.
If the TnCCLR bit in the TMnC1 register is high then the counter will be cleared when a compare
match occurs from Comparator A. However, here only the TnAF interrupt request flag will be
generated even if the value of the CCRP bits is less than that of the CCRA registers. Therefore when
TnCCLR is high no TnPF interrupt request flag will be generated. If the CCRA bits are all zero, the
counter will overflow when its reaches its maximum 10-bit, 3FF Hex, value, however here the TnAF
interrupt request flag will not be generated.
As the name of the mode suggests, after a comparison is made, the TM output pin will change state.
The TM output pin condition however only changes state when an TnAF interrupt request flag
is generated after a compare match occurs from Comparator A. The TnPF interrupt request flag,
generated from a compare match occurs from Comparator P, will have no effect on the TM output
pin. The way in which the TM output pin changes state are determined by the condition of the
TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits in the TMnC1 register. The TM output pin can be selected using the TnIO1
and TnIO0 bits to go high, to go low or to toggle from its present condition when a compare match
occurs from Comparator A. The initial condition of the TM output pin, which is setup after the
TnON bit changes from low to high, is setup using the TnOC bit. Note that if the TnIO1 and TnIO0
bits are zero then no pin change will take place.
Rev. 1.00
107
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TinyPower
TM
Counte� Value
Counte� ove�flow
CCRP=0
0x�FF
TnCCLR = 0; Tn� [1:0] = 00
CCRP > 0
Counte� �lea�ed by CCRP value
CCRP > 0
Counte�
Resta�t
Resume
CCRP
Pause
CCRA
Stop
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnPOL
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
T� O/P Pin
Output pin set to
initial Level Low
if TnOC=0
Output not affe�ted by TnAF
flag. Remains Hig� until �eset
by TnON bit
Output Toggle wit�
TnAF flag
He�e TnIO [1:0] = 11
Toggle Output sele�t
Note TnIO [1:0] = 10
A�tive Hig� Output sele�t
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnPOL is �ig�
Output Pin
Reset to Initial value
Output �ont�olled by
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
Compare Match Output Mode – TnCCLR=0
Note: 1. With TnCCLR=0, a Comparator P match will clear the counter
2. The TM output pin is controlled only by the TnAF flag
3. The output pin is reset to its initial state by a TnON bit rising edge
4. n=0
Rev. 1.00
108
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
TnCCLR = 1; Tn� [1:0] = 00
CCRA = 0
Counte� ove�flow
CCRA > 0 Counte� �lea�ed by CCRA value
0x�FF
CCRA=0
Resume
CCRA
Pause
Stop
Counte� Resta�t
CCRP
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnPOL
No TnAF flag
gene�ated on
CCRA ove�flow
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
TnPF not
gene�ated
Output does
not ��ange
T� O/P Pin
Output pin set to
initial Level Low
if TnOC=0
Output not affe�ted by
TnAF flag. Remains Hig�
until �eset by TnON bit
Output Toggle wit�
TnAF flag
He�e TnIO [1:0] = 11
Toggle Output sele�t
Note TnIO [1:0] = 10
A�tive Hig� Output sele�t
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnPOL is �ig�
Output Pin
Reset to Initial value
Output �ont�olled by
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
Compare Match Output Mode – TnCCLR=1
Note: 1. With TnCCLR=1, a Comparator A match will clear the counter
2. The TM output pin is controlled only by the TnAF flag
3. The output pin is reset to its initial state by a TnON bit rising edge
4. The TnPF flag is not generated when TnCCLR=1
5. n=0
Rev. 1.00
109
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Timer/Counter Mode
To select this mode, bits TnM1 and TnM0 in the TMnC1 register should be set to 11 respectively.
The Timer/Counter Mode operates in an identical way to the Compare Match Output Mode
generating the same interrupt flags. The exception is that in the Timer/Counter Mode the TM output
pin is not used. Therefore the above description and Timing Diagrams for the Compare Match
Output Mode can be used to understand its function. As the TM output pin is not used in this mode,
the pin can be used as a normal I/O pin or other pin-shared function.
PWM Output Mode
To select this mode, bits TnM1 and TnM0 in the TMnC1 register should be set to 10 respectively.
The PWM function within the TM is useful for applications which require functions such as motor
control, heating control, illumination control etc. By providing a signal of fixed frequency but
of varying duty cycle on the TM output pin, a square wave AC waveform can be generated with
varying equivalent DC RMS values.
As both the period and duty cycle of the PWM waveform can be controlled, the choice of generated
waveform is extremely flexible. In the PWM mode, the TnCCLR bit has no effect on the PWM
operation. Both of the CCRA and CCRP registers are used to generate the PWM waveform, one
register is used to clear the internal counter and thus control the PWM waveform frequency, while
the other one is used to control the duty cycle. Which register is used to control either frequency
or duty cycle is determined using the TnDPX bit in the TMnC1 register. The PWM waveform
frequency and duty cycle can therefore be controlled by the values in the CCRA and CCRP registers.
An interrupt flag, one for each of the CCRA and CCRP, will be generated when a compare match
occurs from either Comparator A or Comparator P. The TnOC bit in the TMnC1 register is used to
select the required polarity of the PWM waveform while the two TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits are used to
enable the PWM output or to force the TM output pin to a fixed high or low level. The TnPOL bit is
used to reverse the polarity of the PWM output waveform.
CTM, PWM Mode, Edge-aligned Mode, T0DPX=0
CCRP
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
000b
Period
128
256
384
512
640
768
896
1024
Duty
CCRA
If fSYS=16MHz, TM clock source is fSYS/4, CCRP=100b and CCRA=128,
The CTM PWM output frequency=(fSYS/4)/512=fSYS/2048=7.8125kHz, duty=128/512=25%.
If the Duty value defined by the CCRA register is equal to or greater than the Period value, then the
PWM output duty is 100%.
CTM, PWM Mode, Edge-aligned Mode, T0DPX=1
CCRP
001b
010b
011b
100b
128
256
384
512
Period
Duty
101b
110b
111b
000b
768
896
1024
CCRA
640
The PWM output period is determined by the CCRA register value together with the TM clock
while the PWM duty cycle is defined by the CCRP register value.
Rev. 1.00
110
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
TnDPX = 0; Tn� [1:0] = 10
Counte� �lea�ed
by CCRP
Counte� Reset w�en
TnON �etu�ns �ig�
CCRP
Pause Resume
CCRA
Counte� Stop if
TnON bit low
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnPOL
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=1)
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=0)
PW� Duty Cy�le
set by CCRA
PW� Pe�iod
set by CCRP
PW� �esumes
ope�ation
Output �ont�olled by
Output Inve�ts
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
w�en TnPOL = 1
PWM Mode – TnDPX=0
Note: 1. Here TnDPX=0 -- Counter cleared by CCRP
2. A counter clear sets the PWM Period
3. The internal PWM function continues running even when TnIO [1:0]=00 or 01
4. The TnCCLR bit has no influence on PWM operation
5. n=0
Rev. 1.00
111
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Counte� Value
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TnDPX = 1; Tn� [1:0] = 10
Counte� �lea�ed
by CCRA
Counte� Reset w�en
TnON �etu�ns �ig�
CCRA
Pause Resume
CCRP
Counte� Stop if
TnON bit low
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnPOL
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=1)
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=0)
PW� Duty Cy�le
set by CCRP
PW� Pe�iod
set by CCRA
PW� �esumes
ope�ation
Output �ont�olled by
Output Inve�ts
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
w�en TnPOL = 1
PWM Mode – TnDPX=1
Note: 1. Here TnDPX=1 – Counter cleared by CCRA
2. A counter clear sets the PWM Period
3. The internal PWM function continues running even when TnIO [1:0]=00 or 01
4. The TnCCLR bit has no influence on PWM operation
5. n=0
Rev. 1.00
112
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Standard Type TM – STM
The Standard Type TM contains five operating modes, which are Compare Match Output,
Timer/Event Counter, Capture Input, Single Pulse Output and PWM Output modes. The Standard
TM can also be controlled with an external input pin and can drive one or two external output pins.
Device
TM Type
TM Name.
TM Input Pin
TM Output Pin
HT69F30A
10-bit STM
TM1
TCK1
TP1_0, TP1_1
HT69F40A
10-bit STM
TM2
TCK2
TP2_0, TP2_1
HT69F50A
16-bit STM
TM2
TCK2
TP2_0, TP2_1
Standard TM Operation
There are two sizes of Standard TMs, one is 10-bits wide and the other is 16-bits wide. At the core is
a 10 or 16-bit count-up counter which is driven by a user selectable internal or external clock source.
There are also two internal comparators with the names, Comparator A and Comparator P. These
comparators will compare the value in the counter with CCRP and CCRA registers. The CCRP
comparator is 3 or 8-bits wide whose value is compared the with highest 3 or 8 bits in the counter
while the CCRA is the ten or sixteen bits and therefore compares all counter bits.
The only way of changing the value of the 10 or 16-bit counter using the application program, is
to clear the counter by changing the TnON bit from low to high. The counter will also be cleared
automatically by a counter overflow or a compare match with one of its associated comparators.
When these conditions occur, a TM interrupt signal will also usually be generated. The Standard
Type TM can operate in a number of different operational modes, can be driven by different clock
sources including an input pin and can also control an output pin. All operating setup conditions are
selected using relevant internal registers.
  ‰Š
‹ Š
‰Š
€Œ
             
  
­   ‹ Š
‰Ž € 
‰Ž € Œ
‰Š ‘
 ’  “  ƒ
† ­ † ­
­
 ‡


­  €   ˆ
ˆ ­   † ­
‚ ƒ „ 
  Standard Type TM Block Diagram (n=1 or 2)
Rev. 1.00
113
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Standard Type TM Register Description
Overall operation of the Standard TM is controlled using a series of registers. A read only register
pair exists to store the internal counter 10 or 16-bit value, while a read/write register pair exists to
store the internal 10 or 16-bit CCRA value. The remaining two registers are control registers which
setup the different operating and control modes as well as the three or eight CCRP bits.
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TM1C0
T1PAU
T1CK2
T1CK1
T1CK0
T1ON
T1RP2
T1RP1
T1RP0
TM1C1
T1M1
T1M0
T1IO1
T1IO0
T1OC
T1POL
T1DPX
T1CCLR
TM1DL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TM1DH
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
TM1AL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TM1AH
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
10-bit Standard TM Register List – HT69F30A
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TM2C0
T2PAU
T2CK2
T2CK1
T2CK0
T2ON
T2RP2
T2RP1
T2RP0
TM2C1
T2M1
T2M0
T2IO1
T2IO0
T2OC
T2POL
T2DPX
T2CCLR
TM2DL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TM2DH
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
TM2AL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TM2AH
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
Bit 0
10-bit Standard TM Register List – HT69F40A
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
TM2C0
T2PAU
T2CK2
T2CK1
T2CK0
T2ON
—
—
—
TM2C1
T2M1
T2M0
T2IO1
T2IO0
T2OC
T2POL
T2DPX
T2CCLR
D0
TM2DL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
TM2DH
D15
D14
D13
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
TM2AL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TM2AH
D15
D14
D13
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
TM2RP
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
16-bit Standard TM Register List – HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
114
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
10-bit STM Register Definitions – n=1 for HT69F30A and n=2 for HT69F40A
• TMnC0 Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
TnPAU
TnCK2
TnCK1
TnCK0
TnON
TnRP2
TnRP1
TnRP0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6~4
Bit 3
Bit 2~0
Rev. 1.00
TnPAU: TMn Counter Pause Control
0: Run
1: Pause
The counter can be paused by setting this bit high. Clearing the bit to zero restores
normal counter operation. When in a Pause condition the TM will remain powered up
and continue to consume power. The counter will retain its residual value when this bit
changes from low to high and resume counting from this value when the bit changes
to a low value again.
TnCK2, TnCK1, TnCK0: Select TMn Counter clock
000: fSYS/4
001: fSYS
010: fH/16
011: fH/64
100: fSUB
101: Reserved
110: TCKn rising edge clock
111: TCKn falling edge clock
These three bits are used to select the clock source for the TMn. Selecting the
Reserved clock input will effectively disable the internal counter. The external pin
clock source can be chosen to be active on the rising or falling edge. The clock source
fSYS is the system clock, while fH and fSUB are other internal clocks, the details of which
can be found in the oscillator section.
TnON: TMn Counter On/Off Control
0: Off
1: On
This bit controls the overall on/off function of the TM. Setting the bit high enables the
counter to run, clearing the bit disables the TM. Clearing this bit to zero will stop the
counter from counting and turn off the TM which will reduce its power consumption.
When the bit changes state from low to high the internal counter value will be reset to
zero, however when the bit changes from high to low, the internal counter will retain
its residual value until the bit returns high again. If the TM is in the Compare Match
Output Mode then the TM output pin will be reset to its initial condition, as specified
by the TnOC bit, when the TnON bit changes from low to high.
TnRP2~TnRP0: TMn CCRP 3-bit register, compared with the TMn Counter bit 9~bit 7
Comparator P Match Period
000: 1024 TMn clocks
001: 128 TMn clocks
010: 256 TMn clocks
011: 384 TMn clocks
100: 512 TMn clocks
101: 640 TMn clocks
110: 768 TMn clocks
111: 896 TMn clocks
These three bits are used to setup the value on the internal CCRP 3-bit register, which
are then compared with the internal counter’s highest three bits. The result of this
comparison can be selected to clear the internal counter if the TnCCLR bit is set to
zero. Setting the TnCCLR bit to zero ensures that a compare match with the CCRP
values will reset the internal counter. As the CCRP bits are only compared with the
highest three counter bits, the compare values exist in 128 clock cycle multiples.
Clearing all three bits to zero is in effect allowing the counter to overflow at its
maximum value.
115
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
• TMnC1 Register - 10-bit STM
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
TnM1
TnM0
TnIO1
TnIO0
TnOC
TnPOL
TnDPX
TnCCLR
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~6
TnM1~TnM0: Select TMn Operating Mode
00: Compare Match Output Mode
01: Capture Input Mode
10: PWM Mode or Single Pulse Output Mode
11: Timer/Counter Mode
These bits setup the required operating mode for the TM. To ensure reliable operation
the TM should be switched off before any changes are made to the TnM1 and TnM0
bits. In the Timer/Counter Mode, the TM output pin control must be disabled.
Bit 5~4
TnIO1~TnIO0: Select TPn_0, TPn_1 output function
Compare Match Output Mode
00: No change
01: Output low
10: Output high
11: Toggle output
PWM Mode/Single Pulse Output Mode
00: PWM Output inactive state
01: PWM Output active state
10: PWM output
11: Single pulse output
Capture Input Mode
00: Input capture at rising edge of TPn_0, TPn_1
01: Input capture at falling edge of TPn_0, TPn_1
10: Input capture at falling/rising edge of TPn_0, TPn_1
11: Input capture disabled
Timer/counter Mode
Unused
These two bits are used to determine how the TM output pin changes state when a
certain condition is reached. The function that these bits select depends upon in which
mode the TM is running.
In the Compare Match Output Mode, the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits determine how the
TM output pin changes state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A.
The TM output pin can be setup to switch high, switch low or to toggle its present
state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A. When the bits are both
zero, then no change will take place on the output. The initial value of the TM output
pin should be setup using the TnOC bit in the TMnC1 register. Note that the output
level requested by the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits must be different from the initial value
setup using the TnOC bit otherwise no change will occur on the TM output pin when
a compare match occurs. After the TM output pin changes state it can be reset to its
initial level by changing the level of the TnON bit from low to high.
In the PWM Mode, the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits determine how the TM output pin
changes state when a certain compare match condition occurs. The PWM output
function is modified by changing these two bits. It is necessary to only change
the values of the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits only after the TM has been switched off.
Unpredictable PWM outputs will occur if the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits are changed when
the TM is running.
116
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Rev. 1.00
Bit 3
TnOC: TPn_0, TPn_1 Output control bit
Compare Match Output Mode
0: Initial low
1: Initial high
PWM Mode/Single Pulse Output Mode
0: Active low
1: Active high
This is the output control bit for the TM output pin. Its operation depends upon
whether TM is being used in the Compare Match Output Mode or in the PWM Mode/
Single Pulse Output Mode. It has no effect if the TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode. In
the Compare Match Output Mode it determines the logic level of the TM output pin
before a compare match occurs. In the PWM Mode it determines if the PWM signal is
active high or active low.
Bit 2
TnPOL: TPn_0, TPn_1 Output polarity Control
0: Non-invert
1: Invert
This bit controls the polarity of the TPn_0 or TPn_1 output pin. When the bit is set
high the TM output pin will be inverted and not inverted when the bit is zero. It has no
effect if the TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode.
Bit 1
TnDPX: TMn PWM period/duty Control
0: CCRP - period; CCRA - duty
1: CCRP - duty; CCRA - period
This bit, determines which of the CCRA and CCRP registers are used for period and
duty control of the PWM waveform.
Bit 0
TnCCLR: Select TMn Counter clear condition
0: TMn Comparator P match
1: TMn Comparator A match
This bit is used to select the method which clears the counter. Remember that the
Standard TM contains two comparators, Comparator A and Comparator P, either of
which can be selected to clear the internal counter. With the TnCCLR bit set high,
the counter will be cleared when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A.
When the bit is low, the counter will be cleared when a compare match occurs from
the Comparator P or with a counter overflow. A counter overflow clearing method can
only be implemented if the CCRP bits are all cleared to zero. The TnCCLR bit is not
used in the PWM, Single Pulse or Input Capture Mode.
117
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
• TMnDL Register – 10-bit STM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TMnDL: TMn Counter Low Byte Register bit 7~bit 0
TMn 10-bit Counter bit 7~bit 0
• TMnDH Register – 10-bit STM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
R
R
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~2
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 1~0
TMnDH: TMn Counter High Byte Register bit 1~bit 0
TMn 10-bit Counter bit 9~bit 8
• TMnAL Register – 10-bit STM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
Bit 7~0
TMnAL: TMn CCRA Low Byte Register bit 7~bit 0
TMn 10-bit CCRA bit 7~bit 0
• TMnAH Register – 10-bit STM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~2
Bit 1~0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
TMnAH: TMn CCRA High Byte Register bit 1~bit 0
TM1 10-bit CCRA bit 9~bit 8
Rev. 1.00
118
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
16-bit STM Register Definitions – HT69F50A
• TM2C0 Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T2PAU
T2CK2
T2CK1
T2CK0
T2ON
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
POR
0
0
0
0
0
—
—
—
Bit 7
T2PAU: TM2 Counter Pause Control
0: Run
1: Pause
The counter can be paused by setting this bit high. Clearing the bit to zero restores
normal counter operation. When in a Pause condition the TM will remain powered up
and continue to consume power. The counter will retain its residual value when this bit
changes from low to high and resume counting from this value when the bit changes
to a low value again.
Bit 6~4
T2CK2, T2CK1, T2CK0: Select TM2 Counter clock
000: fSYS/4
001: fSYS
010: fH/16
011: fH/64
100: fSUB
101: Reserved
110: TCK2 rising edge clock
111: TCK2 falling edge clock
These three bits are used to select the clock source for the TM2. Selecting the
Reserved clock input will effectively disable the internal counter. The external pin
clock source can be chosen to be active on the rising or falling edge. The clock source
fSYS is the system clock, while fH and fSUB are other internal clocks, the details of which
can be found in the oscillator section.
Bit 3
T2ON: TM2 Counter On/Off Control
0: Off
1: On
This bit controls the overall on/off function of the TM. Setting the bit high enables the
counter to run, clearing the bit disables the TM. Clearing this bit to zero will stop the
counter from counting and turn off the TM which will reduce its power consumption.
When the bit changes state from low to high the internal counter value will be reset to
zero, however when the bit changes from high to low, the internal counter will retain
its residual value until the bit returns high again. If the TM is in the Compare Match
Output Mode then the TM output pin will be reset to its initial condition, as specified
by the T2OC bit, when the T2ON bit changes from low to high.
Bit 2~0
Unimplemented, read as “0”
119
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
• TM2C1 Register – 16-bit STM
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T2M1
T2M0
T2IO1
T2IO0
T2OC
T2POL
T2DPX
T2CCLR
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~6
T2M1~T2M0: Select TM2 Operating Mode
00: Compare Match Output Mode
01: Capture Input Mode
10: PWM Mode or Single Pulse Output Mode
11: Timer/Counter Mode
These bits setup the required operating mode for the TM. To ensure reliable operation
the TM should be switched off before any changes are made to the T2M1 and T2M0
bits. In the Timer/Counter Mode, the TM output pin control must be disabled.
Bit 5~4
T2IO1~T2IO0: Select TP2_0, TP2_1 output function
Compare Match Output Mode
00: No change
01: Output low
10: Output high
11: Toggle output
PWM Mode/Single Pulse Output Mode
00: PWM output inactive state
01: PWM output active state
10: PWM output
11: Single pulse output
Capture Input Mode
00: Input capture at rising edge of TP2_0, TP2_1
01: Input capture at falling edge of TP2_0, TP2_1
10: Input capture at falling/rising edge of TP2_0, TP2_1
11: Input capture disabled
Timer/counter Mode
Unused
These two bits are used to determine how the TM output pin changes state when a
certain condition is reached. The function that these bits select depends upon in which
mode the TM is running.
In the Compare Match Output Mode, the T2IO1 and T2IO0 bits determine how the
TM output pin changes state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A.
The TM output pin can be setup to switch high, switch low or to toggle its present
state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A. When the bits are both
zero, then no change will take place on the output. The initial value of the TM output
pin should be setup using the T2OC bit in the TM2C1 register. Note that the output
level requested by the T2IO1 and T2IO0 bits must be different from the initial value
setup using the T2OC bit otherwise no change will occur on the TM output pin when
a compare match occurs. After the TM output pin changes state it can be reset to its
initial level by changing the level of the T2ON bit from low to high.
In the PWM Mode, the T2IO1 and T2IO0 bits determine how the TM output pin
changes state when a certain compare match condition occurs. The PWM output
function is modified by changing these two bits. It is necessary to only change
the values of the T2IO1 and T2IO0 bits only after the TM has been switched off.
Unpredictable PWM outputs will occur if the T2IO1 and T2IO0 bits are changed when
the TM is running.
120
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Rev. 1.00
Bit 3
T2OC: TP2_0, TP2_1 Output control bit
Compare Match Output Mode
0: Initial low
1: Initial high
PWM Mode/Single Pulse Output Mode
0: Active low
1: Active high
This is the output control bit for the TM output pin. Its operation depends upon
whether TM is being used in the Compare Match Output Mode or in the PWM Mode/
Single Pulse Output Mode. It has no effect if the TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode. In
the Compare Match Output Mode it determines the logic level of the TM output pin
before a compare match occurs. In the PWM Mode it determines if the PWM signal is
active high or active low.
Bit 2
T2POL: TP2_0, TP2_1 Output polarity Control
0: Non-invert
1: Invert
This bit controls the polarity of the TP2_0 or TP2_1 output pin. When the bit is set
high the TM output pin will be inverted and not inverted when the bit is zero. It has no
effect if the TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode.
Bit 1
T2DPX: TM2 PWM period/duty Control
0: CCRP - period; CCRA - duty
1: CCRP - duty; CCRA - period
This bit, determines which of the CCRA and CCRP registers are used for period and
duty control of the PWM waveform.
Bit 0
T2CCLR: Select TM2 Counter clear condition
0: TM2 Comparator P match
1: TM2 Comparator A match
This bit is used to select the method which clears the counter. Remember that the
Standard TM contains two comparators, Comparator A and Comparator P, either of
which can be selected to clear the internal counter. With the T2CCLR bit set high,
the counter will be cleared when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A.
When the bit is low, the counter will be cleared when a compare match occurs from
the Comparator P or with a counter overflow. A counter overflow clearing method can
only be implemented if the CCRP bits are all cleared to zero. The T1CCLR bit is not
used in the PWM, Single Pulse or Input Capture Mode.
121
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
• TM2DL Register – 16-bit STM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TM2DL: TM2 Counter Low Byte Register bit 7~bit 0
TM2 16-bit Counter bit 7~bit 0
• TM2DH Register – 16-bit STM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D15
D14
D13
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TM2DH: TM2 Counter High Byte Register bit 7~bit 0
TM2 16-bit Counter bit 15~bit 8
• TM2AL Register – 16-bit STM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TM2AL: TM2 CCRA Low Byte Register bit 7~bit 0
TM2 16-bit CCRA bit 7~bit 0
• TM2AH Register – 16-bit STM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D15
D14
D13
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TM2AH: TM2 CCRA High Byte Register bit 7~bit 0
TM2 16-bit CCRA bit 15~bit 8
• TM2RP Register – 16-bit STM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
Rev. 1.00
TM2RP: TM2 CCRP Register bit 7~bit 0
TM2 CCRP 8-bit register, compared with the TM2 Counter bit 15~bit 8.
Comparator P Match Period
0: 65536 TM2 clocks
1~255: 256×(1~255) TM2 clocks
These eight bits are used to setup the value on the internal CCRP 8-bit register, which
are then compared with the internal counter’s highest eight bits. The result of this
comparison can be selected to clear the internal counter if the T2CCLR bit is set to
zero. Setting the T2CCLR bit to zero ensures that a compare match with the CCRP
values will reset the internal counter. As the CCRP bits are only compared with the
highest eight counter bits, the compare values exist in 256 clock cycle multiples.
Clearing all eight bits to zero is in effect allowing the counter to overflow at its
maximum value.
122
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Standard Type TM Operating Modes
The Standard Type TM can operate in one of five operating modes, Compare Match Output Mode,
PWM Output Mode, Single Pulse Output Mode, Capture Input Mode or Timer/Counter Mode. The
operating mode is selected using the TnM1 and TnM0 bits in the TMnC1 register.
Compare Output Mode
To select this mode, bits TnM1 and TnM0 in the TMnC1 register, should be set to 00 respectively.
In this mode once the counter is enabled and running it can be cleared by three methods. These are
a counter overflow, a compare match from Comparator A and a compare match from Comparator P.
When the TnCCLR bit is low, there are two ways in which the counter can be cleared. One is when
a compare match from Comparator P, the other is when the CCRP bits are all zero which allows
the counter to overflow. Here both TnAF and TnPF interrupt request flags for Comparator A and
Comparator P respectively, will both be generated.
If the TnCCLR bit in the TMnC1 register is high then the counter will be cleared when a compare
match occurs from Comparator A. However, here only the TnAF interrupt request flag will be
generated even if the value of the CCRP bits is less than that of the CCRA registers. Therefore when
TnCCLR is high no TnPF interrupt request flag will be generated. In the Compare Match Output
Mode, the CCRA can not be set to "0".
As the name of the mode suggests, after a comparison is made, the TM output pin, will change
state. The TM output pin condition however only changes state when an TnAF interrupt request
flag is generated after a compare match occurs from Comparator A. The TnPF interrupt request flag,
generated from a compare match occurs from Comparator P, will have no effect on the TM output
pin. The way in which the TM output pin changes state are determined by the condition of the
TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits in the TMnC1 register. The TM output pin can be selected using the TnIO1
and TnIO0 bits to go high, to go low or to toggle from its present condition when a compare match
occurs from Comparator A. The initial condition of the TM output pin, which is setup after the
TnON bit changes from low to high, is setup using the TnOC bit. Note that if the TnIO1 and TnIO0
bits are zero then no pin change will take place.
Rev. 1.00
123
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Counte� Value
CCRP = 0
TnCCLR = 0; Tn�[1:0] = 00
Counte�
ove�flow
0x�FF/
0xFFFF
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
CCRP > 0
Counte� �lea�ed by CCRP value
CCRP > 0
CCRP
Pause Resume
CCRA
Stop
Counte�
Reset
Time
TnON bit
TnPAU bit
TnPOL bit
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
T� O/P Pin
Output Pin set
to Initial Level
Low if TnOC = 0
Output Toggle
wit� TnAF flag
Now TnIO1� TnIO0 = 10
A�tive Hig� Output
Sele�t
Output not affe�ted by
TnAF flag. Remains Hig�
until �eset by TnON bit
He�e TnIO1� TnIO0 = 11
Toggle Output Sele�t
Output inve�ts
w�en TnPOL is �ig�
Output Pin
Reset to initial value
Output �ont�olled
by ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
Compare Match Output Mode – TnCCLR=0
Note: 1. With TnCCLR=0, a Comparator P match will clear the counter
2. The TM output pin is controlled only by the TnAF flag
3. The output pin is reset to its initial state by a TnON bit rising edge
4. n=1 for HT69F30A; n=2 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
124
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TnCCLR = 1; Tn�[1:0] = 00
Counte� Value
CCRA = 0
Counte� ove�flows
CCRA > 0 Counte� �lea�ed by CCRA value
0x�FF/
0xFFFF
CCRA = 0
CCRA
Pause Resume
Counte�
Reset
Stop
CCRP
Time
TnON bit
TnPAU bit
TnPOL bit
No TnAF flag
gene�ated on
CCRA ove�flow
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
T� O/P Pin
Output does
not ��ange
TnPF not
gene�ated
Output Pin set
to Initial Level
Low if TnOC = 0
Output not affe�ted by
TnAF flag �emains Hig�
until �eset by TnON bit
Output Toggle
wit� TnAF flag
Now TnIO1� TnIO0 = 10
A�tive Hig� Output
Sele�t
Output �ont�olled by
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
Output inve�ts
w�en TnPOL is �ig�
Output Pin
Reset to initial value
He�e TnIO1� TnIO0 = 11
Toggle Output Sele�t
Compare Match Output Mode – TnCCLR=1
Note: 1. With TnCCLR=1, a Comparator A match will clear the counter
2. The TM output pin is controlled only by the TnAF flag
3. The output pin is reset to its initial state by a TnON bit rising edge
4. A TnPF flag is not generated when TnCCLR=1
5. n=1 for HT69F30A; n=2 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
125
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Timer/Counter Mode
To select this mode, bits TnM1 and TnM0 in the TMnC1 register should be set to 11 respectively.
The Timer/Counter Mode operates in an identical way to the Compare Match Output Mode
generating the same interrupt flags. The exception is that in the Timer/Counter Mode the TM output
pin is not used. Therefore the above description and Timing Diagrams for the Compare Match
Output Mode can be used to understand its function. As the TM output pin is not used in this mode,
the pin can be used as a normal I/O pin or other pin-shared function.
PWM Output Mode
To select this mode, bits TnM1 and TnM0 in the TMnC1 register should be set to 10 respectively
and also the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits should be set to 10 respectively. The PWM function within
the TM is useful for applications which require functions such as motor control, heating control,
illumination control etc. By providing a signal of fixed frequency but of varying duty cycle on the
TM output pin, a square wave AC waveform can be generated with varying equivalent DC RMS
values.
As both the period and duty cycle of the PWM waveform can be controlled, the choice of generated
waveform is extremely flexible. In the PWM mode, the TnCCLR bit has no effect as the PWM
period. Both of the CCRA and CCRP registers are used to generate the PWM waveform, one register
is used to clear the internal counter and thus control the PWM waveform frequency, while the other
one is used to control the duty cycle. Which register is used to control either frequency or duty cycle
is determined using the TnDPX bit in the TMnC1 register. The PWM waveform frequency and duty
cycle can therefore be controlled by the values in the CCRA and CCRP registers.
An interrupt flag, one for each of the CCRA and CCRP, will be generated when a compare match
occurs from either Comparator A or Comparator P. The TnOC bit in the TMnC1 register is used to
select the required polarity of the PWM waveform while the two TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits are used to
enable the PWM output or to force the TM output pin to a fixed high or low level. The TnPOL bit is
used to reverse the polarity of the PWM output waveform.
Rev. 1.00
126
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
10-bit STM, PWM Mode, Edge-aligned Mode, TnDPX=0
CCRP
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
000b
Period
128
256
384
512
640
768
896
1024
Duty
CCRA
If fSYS=16MHz, TM clock source select fSYS/4, CCRP=100b and CCRA=128,
The STM PWM output frequency=(fSYS/4)/512=fSYS/2048=7.8125kHz, duty=128/512=25%
If the Duty value defined by the CCRA register is equal to or greater than the Period value, then the
PWM output duty is 100%.
10-bit STM, PWM Mode, Edge-aligned Mode, TnDPX=1
CCRP
001b
010b
011b
100b
Period
Duty
101b
110b
111b
000b
768
896
1024
CCRA
128
256
384
512
640
The PWM output period is determined by the CCRA register value together with the TM clock
while the PWM duty cycle is defined by the CCRP register value.
16-bit STM, PWM Mode, Edge-aligned Mode, TnDPX=0
CCRP
1~255
000b
Period
CCRP×256
65536
Duty
CCRA
If fSYS=16MHz, TM clock source select fSYS/4, CCRP=2 and CCRA=128,
The STM PWM output frequency=(fSYS/4)/(2×256)=fSYS/2048=7.8125kHz, duty=128/(2×256)=25%.
If the Duty value defined by the CCRA register is equal to or greater than the Period value, then the
PWM output duty is 100%.
16-bit STM, PWM Mode, Edge-aligned Mode, TnDPX=1
CCRP
1~255
Period
Duty
000b
CCRA
CCRP×256
65536
The PWM output period is determined by the CCRA register value together with the TM clock
while the PWM duty cycle is defined by the (CCRP×256) except when the CCRP value is equal to
000b.
Rev. 1.00
127
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Counte� Value
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TnDPX = 0; Tn� [1:0] = 10
Counte� �lea�ed
by CCRP
Counte� Reset w�en
TnON �etu�ns �ig�
CCRP
Pause Resume
CCRA
Counte� Stop if
TnON bit low
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnPOL
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=1)
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=0)
PW� Duty Cy�le
set by CCRA
PW� Pe�iod
set by CCRP
PW� �esumes
ope�ation
Output �ont�olled by
Output Inve�ts
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
w�en TnPOL = 1
PWM Mode – TnDPX=0
Note: 1. Here TnDPX=0, Counter cleared by CCRP
2. A counter clear sets the PWM Period
3. The internal PWM function continues running even when TnIO [1:0]=00 or 01
4. The TnCCLR bit has no influence on PWM operation
5. n=1 for HT69F30A; n=2 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
128
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
TnDPX = 1; Tn� [1:0] = 10
Counte� �lea�ed
by CCRA
Counte� Reset w�en
TnON �etu�ns �ig�
CCRA
Pause Resume
CCRP
Counte� Stop if
TnON bit low
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnPOL
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=1)
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=0)
PW� Duty Cy�le
set by CCRP
PW� Pe�iod
set by CCRA
PW� �esumes
ope�ation
Output �ont�olled by
Output Inve�ts
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
w�en TnPOL = 1
PWM Mode – TnDPX=1
Note: 1. Here TnDPX=1 -- Counter cleared by CCRA
2. A counter clear sets the PWM Period
3. The internal PWM function continues running even when TnIO [1:0]=00 or 01
4. The TnCCLR bit has no influence on PWM operation
5. n=1 for HT69F30A; n=2 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
129
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Single Pulse Mode
To select this mode, bits TnM1 and TnM0 in the TMnC1 register should be set to 10 respectively
and also the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits should be set to 11 respectively. The Single Pulse Output Mode,
as the name suggests, will generate a single shot pulse on the TM output pin.
The trigger for the pulse output leading edge is a low to high transition of the TnON bit, which can
be implemented using the application program. However in the Single Pulse Mode, the TnON bit
can also be made to automatically change from low to high using the external TCKn pin, which will
in turn initiate the Single Pulse output. When the TnON bit transitions to a high level, the counter
will start running and the pulse leading edge will be generated. The TnON bit should remain high
when the pulse is in its active state. The generated pulse trailing edge will be generated when the
TnON bit is cleared to zero, which can be implemented using the application program or when a
compare match occurs from Comparator A.
However a compare match from Comparator A will also automatically clear the TnON bit and thus
generate the Single Pulse output trailing edge. In this way the CCRA value can be used to control
the pulse width. A compare match from Comparator A will also generate a TM interrupt. The counter
can only be reset back to zero when the TnON bit changes from low to high when the counter
restarts. In the Single Pulse Mode CCRP is not used. The TnCCLR and TnDPX bits are not used in
this Mode.
            Single Pulse Generation
Rev. 1.00
130
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
Tn� [1:0] = 10 ; TnIO [1:0] = 11
Counte� stopped
by CCRA
Counte� Reset w�en
TnON �etu�ns �ig�
CCRA
Pause
Counte� Stops
by softwa�e
Resume
CCRP
Time
TnON
Softwa�e
T�igge�
Auto. set by
TCKn pin
Clea�ed by
CCRA mat��
TCKn pin
Softwa�e
T�igge�
Softwa�e
Softwa�e T�igge�
Clea�
Softwa�e
T�igge�
TCKn pin
T�igge�
TnPAU
TnPOL
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
No CCRP Inte��upts
gene�ated
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=1)
T� O/P Pin
(TnOC=0)
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnPOL = 1
Pulse Widt�
set by CCRA
Single Pulse Mode
Note: 1. Counter stopped by CCRA
2. CCRP is not used
3. The pulse triggered by the TCKn pin or by setting the TnON bit high
4. A TCKn pin active edge will automatically set the TnON bit high
5. In the Single Pulse Mode, TnIO [1:0] must be set to “11” and can not be changed
6. n=1 for HT69F30A; n=2 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
131
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Capture Input Mode
To select this mode bits TnM1 and TnM0 in the TMnC1 register should be set to 01 respectively.
This mode enables external signals to capture and store the present value of the internal counter
and can therefore be used for applications such as pulse width measurements. The external signal is
supplied on the TPn_0 or TPn_1 pin, whose active edge can be either a rising edge, a falling edge or
both rising and falling edges; the active edge transition type is selected using the TnIO1 and TnIO0
bits in the TMnC1 register. The counter is started when the TnON bit changes from low to high
which is initiated using the application program.
When the required edge transition appears on the TPn_0 or TPn_1 pin the present value in the
counter will be latched into the CCRA registers and a TM interrupt generated. Irrespective of what
events occur on the TPn_0 or TPn_1 pin the counter will continue to free run until the TnON bit
changes from high to low. When a CCRP compare match occurs the counter will reset back to zero;
in this way the CCRP value can be used to control the maximum counter value. When a CCRP
compare match occurs from Comparator P, a TM interrupt will also be generated. Counting the
number of overflow interrupt signals from the CCRP can be a useful method in measuring long
pulse widths. The TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits can select the active trigger edge on the TPn_0 or TPn_1
pin to be a rising edge, falling edge or both edge types. If the TnIO1 and TnIO0 bits are both set
high, then no capture operation will take place irrespective of what happens on the TPn_0 or TPn_1
pin, however it must be noted that the counter will continue to run.
As the TPn_0 or TPn_1 pin is pin shared with other functions, care must be taken if the TM is in the Input
Capture Mode. This is because if the pin is setup as an output, then any transitions on this pin may cause
an input capture operation to be executed. The TnCCLR and TnDPX bits are not used in this Mode.
Rev. 1.00
132
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
Tn� [1:0] = 01
Counte� �lea�ed
by CCRP
Counte� Counte�
Reset
Stop
CCRP
YY
Pause
Resume
XX
Time
TnON
TnPAU
T� �aptu�e
pin TPn_x
A�tive
edge
A�tive
edge
A�tive edge
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRA
Value
TnIO [1:0]
Value
XX
00 – Rising edge
YY
01 – Falling edge
XX
10 – Bot� edges
YY
11 – Disable Captu�e
Capture Input Mode
Note: 1. TnM [1:0]=01 and active edge set by the TnIO [1:0] bits
2. A TM Capture input pin active edge transfers the counter value to CCRA
3. TnCCLR bit not used
4. No output function -- TnOC and TnPOL bits are not used
5. CCRP determines the counter value and the counter has a maximum count value when CCRP is equal to zero
6. n=1 for HT69F30A; n=2 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
133
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Enhanced Type TM – ETM
The Enhanced Type TM contains five operating modes, which are Compare Match Output,
Timer/Event Counter, Capture Input, Single Pulse Output and PWM Output modes. The Enhanced
TM can also be controlled with an external input pin and can drive three or four external output pins.
Device
TM Type
TM Name.
TM Input Pin
HT69F30A
—
—
—
—
TCK1
TP1A;
TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TP1B_2,
HT69F40A
HT69F50A
10-bit ETM
TM1
TM Output Pin
Enhanced TM Operation
At its core is a 10-bit count-up/count-down counter which is driven by a user selectable internal
or external clock source. There are three internal comparators with the names, Comparator A,
Comparator B and Comparator P. These comparators will compare the value in the counter with the
CCRA, CCRB and CCRP registers. The CCRP comparator is 3-bits wide whose value is compared
with the highest 3-bits in the counter while CCRA and CCRB are 10-bits wide and therefore
compared with all counter bits.
The only way of changing the value of the 10-bit counter using the application program, is to
clear the counter by changing the TnON bit from low to high. The counter will also be cleared
automatically by a counter overflow or a compare match with one of its associated comparators.
When these conditions occur, a TM interrupt signal will also usually be generated. The Enhanced
Type TM can operate in a number of different operational modes, can be driven by different clock
sources including an input pin and can also control output pins. All operating setup conditions are
selected using relevant internal registers.
†‡
ˆ ‡
†‡
‰
         
­   ˆ ‡
†Š  ‹
†Š ‹ ‰
†‡ Œ
 Ž  ‘  ‚
„ ­ „ ­
­     Œ ­     Œ Œ Œ ­   ­
 
„ ­
€ ‚ ƒ 
   Œ
Œ
  
Œ Œ
­   Œ
Œ „ Œ Œ ­ „ Œ ­
 
Œ € ‚ ƒ 
   ­
„ ­
Enhanced Type TM Block Diagram (n=1)
Rev. 1.00
134
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Enhanced Type TM Register Description
Overall operation of the Enhanced TM is controlled using a series of registers. A read only register
pair exists to store the internal counter 10-bit value, while two read/write register pairs exist to store
the internal 10-bit CCRA and CCRB value. The remaining three registers are control registers which
setup the different operating and control modes as well as the three CCRP bits.
Name
Bit7
Bit6
Bit5
Bit4
Bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
TM1C0
T1PAU
T1CK2
T1CK1
T1CK0
T1ON
T1RP2
T1RP1
T1RP0
TM1C1
T1AM1
T1AM0
T1AIO1
T1AIO0
T1AOC
T1APOL
T1CDN
T1CCLR
TM1C2
T1BM1
T1BM0
T1BIO1
T1BIO0
T1BOC
T1BPOL
TM1DL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
T1PWM1 T1PWM0
TM1DH
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
TM1AL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TM1AH
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
TM1BL
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TM1BH
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
10-bit Enhanced TM Register List
TM1C0 Register – 10-bit ETM
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T1PAU
T1CK2
T1CK1
T1CK0
T1ON
T1RP2
T1RP1
T1RP0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
T1PAU: TM1 Counter Pause Control
0: Run
1: Pause
The counter can be paused by setting this bit high. Clearing the bit to zero restores
normal counter operation. When in a Pause condition the TM will remain powered up
and continue to consume power. The counter will retain its residual value when this bit
changes from low to high and resume counting from this value when the bit changes
to a low value again.
Bit 6~4
T1CK2~T1CK0: Select TM1 Counter clock
000: fSYS/4
001: fSYS
010: fH/16
011: fH/64
100: fSUB
101: Reserved
110: TCK1 rising edge clock
111: TCK1 falling edge clock
These three bits are used to select the clock source for the TM. Selecting the Reserved
clock input will effectively disable the internal counter. The external pin clock source
can be chosen to be active on the rising or falling edge. The clock source fSYS is the
system clock, while fH and fSUB are other internal clocks, the details of which can be
found in the oscillator section.
135
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Rev. 1.00
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Bit 3
T1ON: TM1 Counter On/Off Control
0: Off
1: On
This bit controls the overall on/off function of the TM. Setting the bit high enables the
counter to run, clearing the bit disables the TM. Clearing this bit to zero will stop the
counter from counting and turn off the TM which will reduce its power consumption.
When the bit changes state from low to high the internal counter value will be reset to
zero, however when the bit changes from high to low, the internal counter will retain
its residual value until the bit returns high again.
If the TM is in the Compare Match Output Mode then the TM output pin will be reset
to its initial condition, as specified by the T1OC bit, when the T1ON bit changes from
low to high.
Bit 2~0
T1RP2~T1RP0: TM1 CCRP 3-bit register, compared with the TM1 Counter bit 9~bit 7
Comparator P Match Period
000: 1024 TM1 clocks
001: 128 TM1 clocks
010: 256 TM1 clocks
011: 384 TM1 clocks
100: 512 TM1 clocks
101: 640 TM1 clocks
110: 768 TM1 clocks
111: 896 TM1 clocks
These three bits are used to setup the value on the internal CCRP 3-bit register, which
are then compared with the internal counter highest three bits. The result of this
comparison can be selected to clear the internal counter if the T1CCLR bit is set to
zero. Setting the T1CCLR bit to zero ensures that a compare match with the CCRP
values will reset the internal counter. As the CCRP bits are only compared with the
highest three counter bits, the compare values exist in 128 clock cycle multiples.
Clearing all three bits to zero is in effect allowing the counter to overflow at its
maximum value.
136
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TM1C1 Register – 10-bit ETM
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T1AM1
T1AM0
T1AIO1
T1AIO0
T1AOC
T1APOL
T1CDN
T1CCLR
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~6
T1AM1~T1AM0: Select TM1 CCRA Operating Mode
00: Compare Match Output Mode
01: Capture Input Mode
10: PWM Mode or Single Pulse Output Mode
11: Timer/Counter Mode
These bits setup the required operating mode for the TM. To ensure reliable operation
the TM should be switched off before any changes are made to the T1AM1 and
T1AM0 bits. In the Timer/Counter Mode, the TM output pin control must be disabled.
Bit 5~4
T1AIO1~T1AIO0: Select TP1A output function
Compare Match Output Mode
00: No change
01: Output low
10: Output high
11: Toggle output
PWM Mode/Single Pulse Output Mode
00: PWM output inactive state
01: PWM output active state
10: PWM output
11: Single pulse output
Capture Input Mode
00: Input capture at rising edge of TP1A
01: Input capture at falling edge of TP1A
10: Input capture at falling/rising edge of TP1A
11: Input capture disabled
Timer/counter Mode
Unused
These two bits are used to determine how the TM output pin changes state when a
certain condition is reached. The function that these bits select depends upon in which
mode the TM is running.
In the Compare Match Output Mode, the T1AIO1 and T1AIO0 bits determine how
the TM output pin changes state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator
A. The TM output pin can be setup to switch high, switch low or to toggle its present
state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A. When the bits are both
zero, then no change will take place on the output. The initial value of the TM output
pin should be setup using the T1AOC bit in the TM1C1 register. Note that the output
level requested by the T1AIO1 and T1AIO0 bits must be different from the initial
value setup using the T1AOC bit otherwise no change will occur on the TM output pin
when a compare match occurs. After the TM output pin changes state it can be reset to
its initial level by changing the level of the T1ON bit from low to high.
In the PWM Mode, the T1AIO1 and T1AIO0 bits determine how the TM output pin
changes state when a certain compare match condition occurs. The PWM output
function is modified by changing these two bits. It is necessary to change the values of
the T1AIO1 and T1AIO0 bits only after the TM has been switched off. Unpredictable
PWM outputs will occur if the T1AIO1 and T1AIO0 bits are changed when the TM is
running.
137
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Rev. 1.00
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Bit 3
T1AOC: TP1A Output control bit
Compare Match Output Mode
0: Initial low
1: Initial high
PWM Mode/Single Pulse Output Mode
0: Active low
1: Active high
This is the output control bit for the TM output pin. Its operation depends upon
whether TM is being used in the Compare Match Output Mode or in the PWM Mode/
Single Pulse Output Mode. It has no effect if the TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode. In
the Compare Match Output Mode it determines the logic level of the TM output pin
before a compare match occurs. In the PWM Mode it determines if the PWM signal is
active high or active low.
Bit 2
T1APOL: TP1A Output polarity Control
0: Non-invert
1: Invert
This bit controls the polarity of the TP1A output pin. When the bit is set high the TM
output pin will be inverted and not inverted when the bit is zero. It has no effect if the
TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode.
Bit 1
T1CDN: TM1 Counter count up or down flag
0: Count up
1: Count down
Bit 0
T1CCLR: Select TM1 Counter clear condition
0: TM1 Comparator P match
1: TM1 Comparator A match
This bit is used to select the method which clears the counter. Remember that
the Enhanced TM contains three comparators, Comparator A, Comparator B and
Comparator P, but only Comparator A or Comparator P can be selected to clear the
internal counter. With the T1CCLR bit set high, the counter will be cleared when a
compare match occurs from the Comparator A. When the bit is low, the counter will
be cleared when a compare match occurs from the Comparator P or with a counter
overflow. A counter overflow clearing method can only be implemented if the CCRP
bits are all cleared to zero. The T1CCLR bit is not used in the Single Pulse or Input
Capture Mode.
138
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TM1C2 Register – 10-bit ETM
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
Name
T1BM1
T1BM0
T1BIO1
T1BIO0
T1BOC
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1BPOL T1PWM1 T1PWM0
Bit 7~6
T1BM1~T1BM0: Select TM1 CCRB Operating Mode
00: Compare Match Output Mode
01: Capture Input Mode
10: PWM Mode or Single Pulse Output Mode
11: Timer/Counter mode
These bits setup the required operating mode for the TM. To ensure reliable operation
the TM should be switched off before any changes are made to the T1BM1 and
T1BM0 bits. In the Timer/Counter Mode, the TM output pin control must be disabled.
Bit 5~4
T1BIO1~T1BIO0: Select TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TP1B_2 output function
Compare Match Output Mode
00: No change
01: Output low
10: Output high
11: Toggle output
PWM Mode/Single Pulse Output Mode
00: PWM Output inactive state
01: PWM Output active state
10: PWM output
11: Single pulse output
Capture Input Mode
00: Input capture at rising edge of TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TP1B_2
01: Input capture at falling edge of TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TP1B_2
10: Input capture at falling/rising edge of TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TP1B_2
11: Input capture disabled
Timer/counter Mode
Unused
These two bits are used to determine how the TM output pin changes state when a
certain condition is reached. The function that these bits select depends upon in which
mode the TM is running.
In the Compare Match Output Mode, the T1BIO1 and T1BIO0 bits determine how
the TM output pin changes state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator
A. The TM output pin can be setup to switch high, switch low or to toggle its present
state when a compare match occurs from the Comparator A. When the bits are both
zero, then no change will take place on the output. The initial value of the TM output
pin should be setup using the T1BOC bit in the TM1C2 register. Note that the output
level requested by the T1BIO1 and T1BIO0 bits must be different from the initial
value setup using the T1BOC bit otherwise no change will occur on the TM output pin
when a compare match occurs. After the TM output pin changes state it can be reset to
its initial level by changing the level of the T1ON bit from low to high.
In the PWM Mode, the T1BIO1 and T1BIO0 bits determine how the TM output pin
changes state when a certain compare match condition occurs. The PWM output
function is modified by changing these two bits. It is necessary to only change the
value of the T1BIO1 and T1BIO0 bits only after the TM has been switched off.
Unpredictable PWM outputs will occur if the T1BIO1 and T1BIO0 bits are changed
when the TM is running.
139
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Bit 3
T1BOC: TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TP1B_2 Output control bit
Compare Match Output Mode
0: Initial low
1: Initial high
PWM Mode/Single Pulse Output Mode
0: Active low
1: Active high
This is the output control bit for the TM output pin. Its operation depends upon
whether TM is being used in the Compare Match Output Mode or in the PWM Mode/
Single Pulse Output Mode. It has no effect if the TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode. In
the Compare Match Output Mode it determines the logic level of the TM output pin
before a compare match occurs. In the PWM Mode it determines if the PWM signal is
active high or active low.
Bit 2
T1BPOL: TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TB1B_2 Output polarity Control
0: Non-invert
1: Invert
This bit controls the polarity of the TP1B_0, TP1B_1, TP1B_2 output pin. When the
bit is set high the TM output pin will be inverted and not inverted when the bit is zero.
It has no effect if the TM is in the Timer/Counter Mode.
Bit 1~0
T1PWM1~T1PWM0: Select PWM Mode
00: Edge aligned
01: Centre aligned, compare match on count up
10: Centre aligned, compare match on count down
11: Centre aligned, compare match on count up or down
TM1DL Register – 10-bit ETM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TM1DL: TM1 Counter Low Byte Register bit 7~bit 0
TM1 10-bit Counter bit 7~bit 0
TM1DH Register – 10-bit ETM
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
R
R
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~2
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 1~0
TM1DH: TM1 Counter High Byte Register bit 1~bit 0
TM1 10-bit Counter bit 9~bit 8
140
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TM1AL Register – 10-bit ETM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TM1AL: TM1 CCRA Low Byte Register bit 7~bit 0
TM1 10-bit CCRA bit 7~bit 0
TM1AH Register – 10-bit ETM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
2
1
0
Bit 7~2
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 1~0
TM1AH: TM1 CCRA High Byte Register bit 1~bit 0
TM1 10-bit CCRA bit 9~bit 8
TM1BL Register – 10-bit ETM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7~0
TM1BL: TM1 CCRB Low Byte Register bit 7~bit 0
TM1 10-bit CCRB bit 7~bit 0
TM1BH Register – 10-bit ETM
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
—
—
D9
D8
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~2
Unimplemented, read as "0"
Bit 1~0
TM1BH: TM1 CCRB High Byte Register bit 1~bit 0
TM1 10-bit CCRB bit 9~bit 8
141
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Enhanced Type TM Operating Modes
The Enhanced Type TM can operate in one of five operating modes, Compare Match Output Mode,
PWM Output Mode, Single Pulse Output Mode, Capture Input Mode or Timer/Counter Mode. The
operating mode is selected using the TnAM1 and TnAM0 bits in the TMnC1, and the TnBM1 and
TnBM0 bits in the TMnC2 register.
CCRA Compare
Match Output
Mode
CCRA
Timer/
Counter
Mode
CCRA
PWM
Output
Mode
CCRA
Single
Pulse
Output
Mode
CCRA
Input
Capture
Mode
CCRB Compare Match
Output Mode
√
—
—
—
—
CCRB Timer/Counter Mode
—
√
—
—
—
CCRB PWM Output Mode
—
—
√
—
—
CCRB Single Pulse Output
Mode
—
—
—
√
—
CCRB Input Capture Mode
—
—
—
—
√
ETM Operating Mode
“√”: permitted; “—”: not permitt
Compare Output Mode
To select this mode, bits TnAM1, TnAM0 and TnBM1, TnBM0 in the TMnC1/TMnC2 registers
should be all cleared to zero. In this mode once the counter is enabled and running it can be cleared
by three methods. These are a counter overflow, a compare match from Comparator A and a compare
match from Comparator P. When the TnCCLR bit is low, there are two ways in which the counter
can be cleared. One is when a compare match occurs from Comparator P, the other is when the
CCRP bits are all zero which allows the counter to overflow. Here both the TnAF and TnPF interrupt
request flags for Comparator A and Comparator P respectively, will both be generated.
If the TnCCLR bit in the TMnC1 register is high then the counter will be cleared when a compare
match occurs from Comparator A. However, here only the TnAF interrupt request flag will be
generated even if the value of the CCRP bits is less than that of the CCRA registers. Therefore when
TnCCLR is high no TnPF interrupt request flag will be generated.
As the name of the mode suggests, after a comparison is made, the TM output pin, will change
state. The TM output pin condition however only changes state when an TnAF or TnBF interrupt
request flag is generated after a compare match occurs from Comparator A or Comparator B. The
TnPF interrupt request flag, generated from a compare match from Comparator P, will have no
effect on the TM output pin. The way in which the TM output pin changes state is determined by the
condition of the TnAIO1 and TnAIO0 bits in the TMnC1 register for ETM CCRA, and the TnBIO1
and TnBIO0 bits in the TMnC2 register for ETM CCRB. The TM output pin can be selected using
the TnAIO1, TnAIO0 bits (for the TPnA pin) and TnBIO1, TnBIO0 bits (for the TPnB_0, TPnB_1
or TPnB_2 pins) to go high, to go low or to toggle from its present condition when a compare match
occurs from Comparator A or a compare match occurs from Comparator B. The initial condition
of the TM output pin, which is setup after the TnON bit changes from low to high, is setup using
the TnAOC or TnBOC bit for TPnA or TPnB_0, TPnB_1, TPnB_2 output pins. Note that if the
TnAIO1,TnAIO0 and TnBIO1, TnBIO0 bits are zero then no pin change will take place.
Rev. 1.00
142
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
Counte� ove�flow
CCRP=0
0x�FF
TnCCLR = 0; TnA� [1:0] = 00
CCRP > 0
Counte� �lea�ed by CCRP value
CCRP > 0
Counte�
Resta�t
Resume
CCRP
Pause
CCRA
Stop
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnAPOL
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
TPnA O/P
Pin
Output pin set to
initial Level Low
if TnAOC=0
Output not affe�ted by TnAF
flag. Remains Hig� until �eset
by TnON bit
Output Toggle wit�
TnAF flag
He�e TnAIO [1:0] = 11
Toggle Output sele�t
Note TnAIO [1:0] = 10
A�tive Hig� Output sele�t
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnAPOL is �ig�
Output Pin
Reset to Initial value
Output �ont�olled by
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
ETM CCRA Compare Match Output Mode – TnCCLR=0
Note: 1. With TnCCLR=0, a Comparator P match will clear the counter
2. The TPnA output pin is controlled only by the TnAF flag
3. The output pin is reset to its initial state by a TnON bit rising edge
4. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
143
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TinyPower
TM
Counte� Value
Counte� ove�flow
CCRP=0
0x�FF
TnCCLR = 0; TnB� [1:0] = 00
CCRP > 0
Counte� �lea�ed by CCRP value
CCRP > 0
Counte�
Resta�t
Resume
CCRP
Pause
CCRB
Stop
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnBPOL
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRB Int.
Flag TnBF
TPnB O/P
Pin
Output pin set to
initial Level Low
if TnBOC=0
Output not affe�ted by TnBF
flag. Remains Hig� until �eset
by TnON bit
Output Toggle wit�
TnBF flag
He�e TnBIO [1:0] = 11
Toggle Output sele�t
Note TnBIO [1:0] = 10
A�tive Hig� Output sele�t
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnBPOL is �ig�
Output Pin
Reset to Initial value
Output �ont�olled by
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
ETM CCRB Compare Match Output Mode – TnCCLR=0
Note: 1. With TnCCLR=0, a Comparator P match will clear the counter
2. The TPnB output pin is controlled only by the TnBF flag
3. The output pin is reset to its initial state by a TnON bit rising edge
4. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
144
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
TnCCLR = 1; TnA� [1:0] = 00
CCRA = 0
Counte� ove�flow
CCRA > 0 Counte� �lea�ed by CCRA value
0x�FF
CCRA=0
Resume
CCRA
Pause
Stop
Counte� Resta�t
CCRP
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnAPOL
No TnAF flag
gene�ated on
CCRA ove�flow
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
TnPF not
gene�ated
Output does
not ��ange
TPnA O/P
Pin
Output pin set to
initial Level Low
if TnAOC=0
Output not affe�ted by
TnAF flag. Remains Hig�
until �eset by TnON bit
Output Toggle wit�
TnAF flag
He�e TnAIO [1:0] = 11
Toggle Output sele�t
Note TnAIO [1:0] = 10
A�tive Hig� Output sele�t
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnAPOL is �ig�
Output Pin
Reset to Initial value
Output �ont�olled by
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
ETM CCRA Compare Match Output Mode – TnCCLR=1
Note: 1. With TnCCLR=1, a Comparator A match will clear the counter
2. The TPnA output pin is controlled only by the TnAF flag
3. The TPnA output pin is reset to its initial state by a TnON bit rising edge
4. The TnPF flag is not generated when TnCCLR=1
5. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
145
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
0x�FF
TnCCLR = 1; TnB� [1:0] = 00
CCRA = 0
Counte� ove�flow
CCRA > 0 Counte� �lea�ed by CCRA value
Resume
CCRA
Pause
CCRA=0
Stop
Counte� Resta�t
CCRB
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnBPOL
No TnAF flag
gene�ated on
CCRA ove�flow
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRB Int.
Flag TnBF
TPnB O/P
Pin
Output pin set to
initial Level Low
if TnBOC=0
Output Toggle wit�
TnBF flag
He�e TnBIO [1:0] = 11
Toggle Output sele�t
Output not affe�ted by
TnBF flag. Remains Hig�
until �eset by TnON bit
Note TnBIO [1:0] = 10
A�tive Hig� Output sele�t
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnBPOL is �ig�
Output Pin
Reset to Initial value
Output �ont�olled by
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
ETM CCRB Compare Match Output Mode – TnCCLR=1
Note: 1. With TnCCLR=1, a Comparator A match will clear the counter
2. The TPnB output pin is controlled only by the TnBF flag
3. The TPnB output pin is reset to its initial state by a TnON bit rising edge
4. The TnPF flag is not generated when TnCCLR=1
5. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
146
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Timer/Counter Mode
To select this mode, bits TnAM1, TnAM0 and TnBM1, TnBM0 in the TMnC1 and TMnC2 registers
should all be set high. The Timer/Counter Mode operates in an identical way to the Compare
Match Output Mode generating the same interrupt flags. The exception is that in the Timer/Counter
Mode the TM output pin is not used. Therefore the above description and Timing Diagrams for the
Compare Match Output Mode can be used to understand its function. As the TM output pin is not
used in this mode, the pin can be used as a normal I/O pin or other pin-shared functions.
PWM Output Mode
To select this mode, the required bit pairs, TnAM1, TnAM0 and TnBM1, TnBM0 in the TMnC1
and TMnC2 registers should be set to 10 respectively and also the TnAIO1, TnAIO0 and TnBIO1,
TnBIO0 bits should be set to 10 respectively. The PWM function within the TM is useful for
applications which require functions such as motor control, heating control, illumination control etc.
By providing a signal of fixed frequency but of varying duty cycle on the TM output pin, a square
wave AC waveform can be generated with varying equivalent DC RMS values.
As both the period and duty cycle of the PWM waveform can be controlled, the choice of generated
waveform is extremely flexible. In the PWM mode, the TnCCLR bit is used to determine in which
way the PWM period is controlled. With the TnCCLR bit set high, the PWM period can be finely
controlled using the CCRA registers. In this case the CCRB registers are used to set the PWM
duty value (for TPnB_x output pins). The CCRP bits are not used and TPnA output pin is not used.
The PWM output can only be generated on the TPnB_x output pins. With the TnCCLR bit cleared
to zero, the PWM period is set using one of the eight values of the three CCRP bits, in multiples
of 128. Now both CCRA and CCRB registers can be used to setup different duty cycle values to
provide dual PWM outputs on their relative TPnA and TPnB_x pins.
The TnPWM1 and TnPWM0 bits determine the PWM alignment type, which can be either edge
or centre type. In edge alignment, the leading edge of the PWM signals will all be generated
concurrently when the counter is reset to zero. With all power currents switching on at the same
time, this may give rise to problems in higher power applications. In centre alignment the centre
of the PWM active signals will occur sequentially, thus reducing the level of simultaneous power
switching currents.
Interrupt flags, one for each of the CCRA, CCRB and CCRP, will be generated when a compare
match occurs from the Comparator A, Comparator B or Comparator P. The TnAOC and TnBOC bits
in the TMnC1 and TMnC2 register are used to select the required polarity of the PWM waveform
while the two TnAIO1, TnAIO0 and TnBIO1, TnBIO0 bits pairs are used to enable the PWM output
or to force the TM output pin to a fixed high or low level. The TnAPOL and TnBPOL bit are used to
reverse the polarity of the PWM output waveform.
Rev. 1.00
147
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
ETM, PWM Mode, Edge-aligned Mode, TnCCLR=0
CCRP
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
000b
Period
128
256
384
512
640
768
896
1024
A Duty
CCRA
B Duty
CCRB
If fSYS=12MHz, TM clock source select fSYS/4, CCRP=100b, CCRA=128 and CCRB=256,
The TPnA PWM output frequency=(fSYS/4)/512=fSYS/2048=5.8594kHz, duty=128/512=25%.
The TPnB_x PWM output frequency=(fSYS/4)/512=fSYS/2048=5.8594kHz, duty=256/512=50%.
If the Duty value defined by CCRA or CCRB register is equal to or greater than the Period value,
then the PWM output duty is 100%.
ETM, PWM Mode, Edge-aligned Mode, TnCCLR=1
CCRA
1
2
3
511
512
1021
1022
1023
Period
1
2
3
511
512
1021
1022
1023
B Duty
CCRB
ETM, PWM Mode, Center-aligned Mode, TnCCLR=0
CCRA
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
000b
Period
256
512
768
1024
1280
1536
1792
2046
A Duty
(CCRA×2)-1
B Duty
(CCRB×2)-1
ETM, PWM Mode, Center-aligned Mode, TnCCLR=1
CCRA
1
2
3
511
512
1021
1022
1023
Period
2
4
6
1022
1024
2042
2044
2046
B Duty
Rev. 1.00
(CCRB×2)-1
148
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
TnCCLR = 0;
TnA� [1:0] = 10� TnB� [1:0] = 10;
TnPW� [1:0] = 00
Counte� Clea�ed by CCRP
CCRP
CCRA
Pause
Resume
Stop
CCRB
Counte�
Resta�t
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnAPOL
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRB Int.
Flag TnBF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
TPnA Pin
(TnAOC=1)
TPnB Pin
Duty Cy�le
set by CCRA
Duty Cy�le
set by CCRA
Duty Cy�le
set by CCRA
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnAPOL
is �ig�
(TnBOC=1)
TPnB Pin
(TnBOC=0)
Duty Cy�le
set by CCRB
Output �ont�olled by
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
Output Pin
Reset to Initial value
PW� Pe�iod set by CCRP
ETM PWM Mode – Edge Aligned
Note: 1. Here TnCCLR=0 therefore CCRP clears the counter and determines the PWM period
2. The internal PWM function continues running even when TnAIO [1:0] (or TnBIO [1:0])=00 or 01
3. CCRA controls the TPnA PWM duty and CCRB controls the TPnB PWM duty
4. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
149
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Counte� Value
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TnCCLR = 1; TnB� [1:0] = 10;
TnPW� [1:0] = 00
Counte� Clea�ed by CCRA
CCRA
Pause
Resume
Counte�
Resta�t
Stop
CCRB
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnBPOL
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRB Int.
Flag TnBF
TPnB Pin
(TnBOC=1)
TPnB Pin
(TnBOC=0)
Duty Cy�le
set by CCRB
Output �ont�olled by
ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
PW� Pe�iod set by CCRA
Output Pin
Reset to
Initial value
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnBPOL
is �ig�
ETM PWM Mode – Edge Aligned
Note: 1. Here TnCCLR=1 therefore CCRA clears the counter and determines the PWM period
2. The internal PWM function continues running even when TnBIO [1:0]=00 or 01
3. The CCRA controls the TPnB PWM period and CCRB controls the TPnB PWM duty
4. Here the TM pin control register should not enable the TPnA pin as a TM output pin.
5. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
150
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TnCCLR = 0;
TnA� [1:0] = 10� TnB� [1:0] = 10;
TnPW� [1:0] = 11
Counte� Value
CCRP
Resume
CCRA
Stop
Counte�
Resta�t
Pause
CCRB
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnAPOL
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRB Int.
Flag TnBF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
TPnA Pin
(TnAOC=1)
TPnB Pin
Duty Cy�le set by CCRA
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnAPOL
is �ig�
(TnBOC=1)
TPnB Pin
(TnBOC=0)
Duty Cy�le set by CCRB
Output �ont�olled by
Ot�e� pin-s�a�ed fun�tion
PW� Pe�iod set by CCRP
Output Pin
Reset to Initial value
ETM PWM Mode – Centre Aligned
Note: 1. Here TnCCLR=0 therefore CCRP clears the counter and determines the PWM period
2. TnPWM [1:0]=11 therefore the PWM is centre aligned
3. The internal PWM function continues running even when TnAIO [1:0] (or TnBIO [1:0])=00 or 01
4. CCRA controls the TPnA PWM duty and CCRB controls the TPnB PWM duty
5. CCRP will generate an interrupt request when the counter decrements to its zero value
6. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
151
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Counte� Value
TnCCLR = 1; TnB� [1:0] = 10;
TnPW� [1:0] = 11
CCRA
Resume
Stop
Counte�
Resta�t
Pause
CCRB
Time
TnON
TnPAU
TnBPOL
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRB Int.
Flag TnBF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
TPnB Pin
(TnBOC=1)
TPnB Pin
(TnBOC=0)
Output �ont�olled
Output Inve�ts
by ot�e� pin-s�a�ed
w�en TnBPOL is �ig�
fun�tion
Output Pin
Reset to Initial value
Duty Cy�le set by CCRB
PW� Pe�iod set by CCRA
ETM PWM Mode – Centre Aligned
Note: 1. Here TnCCLR=1 therefore CCRA clears the counter and determines the PWM period
2. TnPWM [1:0]=11 therefore the PWM is centre aligned
3. The internal PWM function continues running even when TnBIO [1:0]=00 or 01
4. CCRA controls the TPnB PWM period and CCRB controls the TPnB PWM duty
5. CCRP will generate an interrupt request when the counter decrements to its zero value
6. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
152
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Single Pulse Output Mode
To select this mode, the required bit pairs, TnAM1, TnAM0 and TnBM1, TnBM0 should be set to
10 respectively and also the corresponding TnAIO1, TnAIO0 and TnBIO1, TnBIO0 bits should be
set to 11 respectively. The Single Pulse Output Mode, as the name suggests, will generate a single
shot pulse on the TM output pin.
The trigger for the pulse TPnA output leading edge is a low to high transition of the TnON bit, which
can be implemented using the application program. The trigger for the pulse TPnB_x output leading
edge is a compare match from Comparator B, which can be implemented using the application
program. However in the Single Pulse Mode, the TnON bit can also be made to automatically
change from low to high using the external TCKn pin, which will in turn initiate the Single Pulse
output of TPnA. When the TnON bit transitions to a high level, the counter will start running and
the pulse leading edge of TPnA will be generated. The TnON bit should remain high when the pulse
is in its active state. The generated pulse trailing edge of TPnA and TPnB_x will be generated when
the TnON bit is cleared to zero, which can be implemented using the application program or when a
compare match occurs from Comparator A.
However a compare match from Comparator A will also automatically clear the TnON bit and thus
generate the Single Pulse output trailing edge of TPnA and TPnB_x. In this way the CCRA value
can be used to control the pulse width of TPnA. The (CCRA-CCRB) value can be used to control
the pulse width of TPnB_x. A compare match from Comparator A and Comparator B will also
generate TM interrupts. The counter can only be reset back to zero when the TnON bit changes from
low to high when the counter restarts. In the Single Pulse Mode CCRP is not used. The TnCCLR bit
is also not used.
Counter Value
CCRA
CCRB
0
S/W Command
SET“TnON”
or
TCKn Pin
Transition
Time
CCRA
Leading Edge
CCRA
Trailing Edge
TnON bit
0→1
TnON bit
1→0
S/W Command
CLR“TnON”
or
CCRA Compare
Match
TPnA Output Pin
Pulse Width = CCRA Value
TPnB Output Pin
Pulse Width = (CCRA-CCRB) Value
CCRB Compare
Match
TnON = 1
TnON bit
1→0
CCRB
Leading Edge
CCRB
Trailing Edge
S/W Command
CLR“TnON”
or
CCRA Compare
Match
Single Pulse Generation
Rev. 1.00
153
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Counte� Value
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TnA� [1:0] = 10� TnB� [1:0] = 10;
TnAIO [1:0] = 11� TnBIO [1:0] = 11
Counte� stopped
by CCRA
CCRA
Pause
Counte� Stops
by softwa�e
Resume
CCRB
Counte� Reset
w�en TnON
�etu�ns �ig�
Time
TnON
Softwa�e
T�igge�
Clea�ed by
CCRA mat��
Auto. set by
TCKn pin
TCKn pin
Softwa�e
T�igge�
Softwa�e
T�igge�
Softwa�e
Clea�
Softwa�e
T�igge�
TCKn pin
T�igge�
TnPAU
TnAPOL
TnBPOL
CCRB Int.
Flag TnBF
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
TPnA Pin
(TnAOC=1)
TPnA Pin
Pulse Widt�
set by CCRA
(TnAOC=0)
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnAPOL=1
TPnB Pin
(TnBOC=1)
TPnB Pin
(TnBOC=0)
Pulse Widt� set
by (CCRA-CCRB)
Output Inve�ts
w�en TnBPOL=1
ETM – Single Pulse Mode
Note: 1. Counter stopped by CCRA
2. CCRP is not used
3. The pulse triggered by the TCKn pin or by setting the TnON bit high
4. A TCKn pin active edge will automatically set the TnON bit high
5. In the Single Pulse Mode, TnAIO [1:0] and TnBIO [1:0] must be set to “11” and can not be changed
6. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
154
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Capture Input Mode
To select this mode bits TnAM1, TnAM0 and TnBM1, TnBM0 in the TMnC1 and TMnC2 registers
should be set to 01 respectively. This mode enables external signals to capture and store the
present value of the internal counter and can therefore be used for applications such as pulse width
measurements. The external signal is supplied on the TPnA and TPnB_0, TPnB_1, TPnB_2 pins,
whose active edge can be either a rising edge, a falling edge or both rising and falling edges; the
active edge transition type is selected using the TnAIO1, TnAIO0 and TnBIO1, TnBIO0 bits in the
TMnC1 and TMnC2 registers. The counter is started when the TnON bit changes from low to high
which is initiated using the application program.
When the required edge transition appears on the TPnA and TPnB_0, TPnB_1, TPnB_2 pins the
present value in the counter will be latched into the CCRA and CCRB registers and a TM interrupt
generated. Irrespective of what events occur on the TPnA and TPnB_0, TPnB_1, TPnB_2 pins
the counter will continue to free run until the TnON bit changes from high to low. When a CCRP
compare match occurs the counter will reset back to zero; in this way the CCRP value can be used
to control the maximum counter value. When a CCRP compare match occurs from Comparator P,
a TM interrupt will also be generated. Counting the number of overflow interrupt signals from the
CCRP can be a useful method in measuring long pulse widths. The TnAIO1, TnAIO0 and TnBIO1,
TnBIO0 bits can select the active trigger edge on the TPnA and TPnB_0, TPnB_1, TPnB_2 pins to be
a rising edge, falling edge or both edge types. If the TnAIO1, TnAIO0 and TnBIO1, TnBIO0 bits are
both set high, then no capture operation will take place irrespective of what happens on the TPnA and
TPnB_0, TPnB_1, TPnB_2 pins, however it must be noted that the counter will continue to run.
As the TPnA and TPnB_0, TPnB_1, TPnB_2 pins are pin shared with other functions, care must
be taken if the TM is in the Capture Input Mode. This is because if the pin is setup as an output,
then any transitions on this pin may cause an input capture operation to be executed. The TnCCLR,
TnAOC, TnBOC, TnAPOL and TnBPOL bits are not used in this mode.
Rev. 1.00
155
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Counte� Value
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TnA� [1:0] = 01
Counte� �lea�ed
by CCRP
Counte� Counte�
Reset
Stop
CCRP
YY
Pause
Resume
XX
Time
TnON
TnPAU
T� �aptu�e
pin TPnA
A�tive
edge
A�tive
edge
A�tive edge
CCRA Int.
Flag TnAF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRA
Value
TnAIO [1:0]
Value
XX
00 – Rising edge
YY
01 – Falling edge
XX
10 – Bot� edges
YY
11 – Disable Captu�e
ETM CCRA Capture Input Mode
Note: 1. TnAM [1:0]=01 and active edge set by the TnAIO [1:0] bits
2. The TM Capture input pin active edge transfers the counter value to CCRA
3. TnCCLR bit not used
4. No output function -- TnAOC and TnAPOL bits not used
5. CCRP determines the counter value and the counter has a maximum count value when CCRP is equal to zero
6. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
156
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TnB�1� TnB�0 = 01
Counte�
Value
Counte�
ove�flow
CCRP
Stop
Counte�
Reset
YY
XX
Pause
Resume
Time
TnON bit
TnPAU bit
T� Captu�e Pin
A�tive
edge
A�tive
edge
A�tive
edges
CCRB Int.
Flag TnBF
CCRP Int.
Flag TnPF
CCRB
Value
TnBIO1� TnBIO0
Value
XX
00 - Rising edge
YY
01 - Falling edge
XX
YY
10 - Bot� edges
11 - Disable Captu�e
ETM CCRB Capture Input Mode
Note: 1. TnBM [1:0]=01 and active edge set by the TnBIO [1:0] bits
2. The TM Capture input pin active edge transfers the counter value to CCRB
3. TnCCLR bit not used
4. No output function -- TnBOC and TnBPOL bits not used
5. CCRP determines the counter value and the counter has a maximum count value when CCRP is equal to zero
6. n=1 for HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
157
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Interrupts
Interrupts are an important part of any microcontroller system. When an external event or an
internal function such as a Timer Module requires microcontroller attention, their corresponding
interrupt will enforce a temporary suspension of the main program allowing the microcontroller to
direct attention to their respective needs. The device contains several external interrupt and internal
interrupts functions. The external interrupts are generated by the action of the external INT0~INT1
pins, while the internal interrupts are generated by various internal functions such as the TMs, Time
Base and LVD.
Interrupt Registers
Overall interrupt control, which basically means the setting of request flags when certain
microcontroller conditions occur and the setting of interrupt enable bits by the application program,
is controlled by a series of registers, located in the Special Purpose Data Memory, as shown in the
accompanying table. The number of registers depends upon the device chosen but fall into three
categories. The first is the INTC0~INTC1 registers which setup the primary interrupts, the second
is the MFI0~MFI2 registers which setup the Multi-function interrupts. Finally there is an INTEG
register to setup the external interrupt trigger edge type.
Each register contains a number of enable bits to enable or disable individual registers as well as
interrupt flags to indicate the presence of an interrupt request. The naming convention of these
follows a specific pattern. First is listed an abbreviated interrupt type, then the (optional) number of
that interrupt followed by either an “E” for enable/disable bit or “F” for request flag.
Function
Global
INTn Pin
Enable Bit
Request Flag
EMI
—
Notes
INTnE
INTnF
n=0~1
—
Time Base
TBnE
TBnF
n=0~1
Multi-function
MFnE
MFnF
n=0~2
LVD
LVE
LVF
EEPROM
DEE
DEF
TnPE
TnPF
n=0~2
TnAE
TnAF
n=0~2
TnBE
TnBF
n=1
TM
—
—
Interrupt Register Bit Naming Conventions
Rev. 1.00
158
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Interrupt Register Contents
• HT69F30A
Name
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
INTEG
—
—
—
—
INT1S1
INT1S0
INT0S1
INT0S0
INTC0
—
TB0F
INT1F
INT0F
TB0E
INT1E
INT0E
EMI
INTC1
MF2F
MF1F
MF0F
TB1F
MF2E
MF1E
MF0E
TB1E
MFI0
—
—
T0AF
T0PF
—
—
T0AE
T0PE
MFI1
—
—
T1AF
T1PF
—
—
T1AE
T1PE
MFI2
—
—
DEF
LVF
—
—
DEE
LVE
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
INT0S0
• HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Name
Bit
7
INTEG
—
—
—
—
INT1S1
INT1S0
INT0S1
INTC0
—
TB0F
INT1F
INT0F
TB0E
INT1E
INT0E
EMI
INTC1
MF2F
MF1F
MF0F
TB1F
MF2E
MF1E
MF0E
TB1E
MFI0
T2AF
T2PF
T0AF
T0PF
T2AE
T2PE
T0AE
T0PE
MFI1
—
T1BF
T1AF
T1PF
—
T1BE
T1AE
T1PE
MFI2
—
—
DEF
LVF
—
—
DEE
LVE
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
—
—
INT1S1
INT1S0
INT0S1
INT0S0
R/W
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
—
—
0
0
0
0
INTEG Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit 7~4
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 3~2
INT1S1, INT1S0: interrupt edge control for INT1 pin
00: Disable
01: Rising edge
10: Falling edge
11: Rising and falling edges
Bit 1~0
INT0S1, INT0S0: interrupt edge control for INT0 pin
00: Disable
01: Rising edge
10: Falling edge
11: Rising and falling edge
159
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
INTC0 Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Name
—
TB0F
INT1F
INT0F
TB0E
INT1E
INT0E
EMI
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
—
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 6
TB0F: Time Base 0 interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 5
INT1F: INT1 interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 4
INT0F: INT0 interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 3
TB0E: Time Base 0 interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 2
INT1E: INT1 interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 1
INT0E: INT0 interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 0
EMI: Global interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
160
0
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
INTC1 Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
MF2F
MF1F
MF0F
TB1F
MF2E
MF1E
MF0E
TB1E
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
MF2F: Multi-function interrupt 2 request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 6
MF1F: Multi-function interrupt 1 request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 5
MF0F: Multi-function interrupt 0 request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 4
TB1F: Time Base 1 interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 3
MF2E: Multi-function interrupt 2 control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 2
MF1E: Multi-function interrupt 1 control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 1
MF0E: Multi-function interrupt 0 control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 0
TB1E: Time Base 1 interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
MFI0 Register – HT69F30A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
T0AF
T0PF
—
—
T0AE
T0PE
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
0
0
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~6
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 5
T0AF: TM0 Comparator A match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 4
T0PF: TM0 Comparator P match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 3~2
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 1
T0AE: TM0 Comparator A match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 0
T0PE: TM0 Comparator P match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
161
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
MFI0 Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
T2AF
T2PF
T0AF
T0PF
T2AE
T2PE
T0AE
T0PE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
T2AF: TM2 Comparator A match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 6
T2PF: TM2 Comparator P match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 5
T0AF: TM0 Comparator A match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 4
T0PF: TM0 Comparator P match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 3
T2AE: TM2 Comparator A match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 2
T2PE: TM2 Comparator P match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 1
T0AE: TM0 Comparator A match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 0
T0PE: TM0 Comparator P match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
MFI1 Register – HT69F30A
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
T1AF
T1PF
—
—
T1AE
T1PE
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
0
0
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~6
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 5
T1AF: TM1 Comparator A match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 4
T1PF: TM1 Comparator P match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 3~2
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 1
T1AE: TM1 Comparator A match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 0
T1PE: TM1 Comparator P match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
162
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
MFI1 Register – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
T1BF
T1AF
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
T1PF
—
T1BE
T1AE
T1PE
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
0
0
R/W
0
—
0
0
0
Bit 7
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 6
T1BF: TM1 Comparator B match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 5
T1AF: TM1 Comparator A match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 4
T1PF: TM1 Comparator P match interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 3
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 2
T1BE: TM1 Comparator B match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 1
T1AE: TM1 Comparator A match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 0
T1PE: TM1 Comparator P match interrupt control
0: Disable
1: Enable
MFI2 Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
DEF
LVF
—
—
DEE
LVE
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
0
0
—
—
0
0
Bit 7~6
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 5
DEF: Data EEPROM interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 4
LVF: LVD interrupt request flag
0: No request
1: Interrupt request
Bit 3~2
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 1
DEE: Data EEPROM Interrupt Control
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 0
LVE: LVD Interrupt Control
0: Disable
1: Enable
163
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Interrupt Operation
When the conditions for an interrupt event occur, such as a TM Comparator P, Comparator A or
Comparator B match etc, the relevant interrupt request flag will be set. Whether the request flag
actually generates a program jump to the relevant interrupt vector is determined by the condition of
the interrupt enable bit. If the enable bit is set high then the program will jump to its relevant vector;
if the enable bit is zero then although the interrupt request flag is set an actual interrupt will not be
generated and the program will not jump to the relevant interrupt vector. The global interrupt enable
bit, if cleared to zero, will disable all interrupts.
When an interrupt is generated, the Program Counter, which stores the address of the next instruction
to be executed, will be transferred onto the stack. The Program Counter will then be loaded with a
new address which will be the value of the corresponding interrupt vector. The microcontroller will
then fetch its next instruction from this interrupt vector. The instruction at this vector will usually
be a “JMP” which will jump to another section of program which is known as the interrupt service
routine. Here is located the code to control the appropriate interrupt. The interrupt service routine
must be terminated with a "RETI" , which retrieves the original Program Counter address from
the stack and allows the microcontroller to continue with normal execution at the point where the
interrupt occurred.
The various interrupt enable bits, together with their associated request flags, are shown in the
accompanying diagrams with their order of priority. Some interrupt sources have their own
individual vector while others share the same multi-function interrupt vector. Once an interrupt
subroutine is serviced, all the other interrupts will be blocked, as the global interrupt enable bit,
EMI bit will be cleared automatically. This will prevent any further interrupt nesting from occurring.
However, if other interrupt requests occur during this interval, although the interrupt will not be
immediately serviced, the request flag will still be recorded.
If an interrupt requires immediate servicing while the program is already in another interrupt service
routine, the EMI bit should be set after entering the routine, to allow interrupt nesting. If the stack
is full, the interrupt request will not be acknowledged, even if the related interrupt is enabled, until
the Stack Pointer is decremented. If immediate service is desired, the stack must be prevented from
becoming full. In case of simultaneous requests, the accompanying diagram shows the priority that
is applied. All of the interrupt request flags when set will wake-up the device if it is in SLEEP or
IDLE Mode, however to prevent a wake-up from occurring the corresponding flag should be set
before the device is in SLEEP or IDLE Mode.
Rev. 1.00
164
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
EMI auto disabled in ISR
Legend
xxF
Request Flag, no auto reset in ISR
xxF
Request Flag, auto reset in ISR
xxE
Enable Bits
TM0 P
T0PF
T0PE
TM0 A
T0AF
T0AE
TM1 P
T1PF
T1PE
TM1 A
T1AF
T1AE
EEPROM
DEF
DEE
LVD
LVF
LVE
Interrupt
Name
INT0 Pin
Request
Flags
INT0F
Enable
Bits
INT0E
Master
Enable
EMI
INT1 Pin
INT1F
INT1E
EMI
08H
Time Base 0
TB0F
TB0E
EMI
0CH
Time Base 1
TB1F
TB1E
EMI
10H
M. Funct. 0
MF0F
MF0E
EMI
14H
M. Funct. 1
MF1F
MF1E
EMI
18H
M. Funct. 2
MF2F
MF2E
EMI
1CH
Vector Priority
High
04H
Low
Interrupts contained within
Multi-Function Interrupts
Interrupt Structure – HT69F30A
EMI auto disabled in ISR
Legend
xxF
Request Flag, no auto reset in ISR
xxF
Request Flag, auto reset in ISR
xxE
Enable Bits
TM2 P
T2PF
T2PE
TM2 A
T2AF
T2AE
TM0 P
T0PF
T0PE
TM0 A
T0AF
T0AE
TM1 P
T1PF
T1PE
TM1 A
T1AF
T1AE
TM1 B
T1BF
T1BE
EEPROM
DEF
DEE
LVD
LVF
LVE
Interrupt
Name
INT0 Pin
Request
Flags
INT0F
Enable
Bits
INT0E
Master
Enable
EMI
INT1 Pin
INT1F
INT1E
EMI
08H
Time Base 0
TB0F
TB0E
EMI
0CH
Time Base 1
TB1F
TB1E
EMI
10H
M. Funct. 0
MF0F
MF0E
EMI
14H
M. Funct. 1
MF1F
MF1E
EMI
18H
M. Funct. 2
MF2F
MF2E
EMI
1CH
Vector Priority
High
04H
Low
Interrupts contained within
Multi-Function Interrupts
Interrupt Structure – HT69F40A/HT69F50A
Rev. 1.00
165
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
External Interrupt
The external interrupts are controlled by signal transitions on the pins INT0~INT1. An external
interrupt request will take place when the external interrupt request flags, INT0F~INT1F, are set,
which will occur when a transition, whose type is chosen by the edge select bits, appears on the
external interrupt pins. To allow the program to branch to its respective interrupt vector address, the
global interrupt enable bit, EMI, and respective external interrupt enable bit, INT0E~INT1E, must
first be set. Additionally the correct interrupt edge type must be selected using the INTEG register to
enable the external interrupt function and to choose the trigger edge type. As the external interrupt
pins are pin-shared with I/O pins, they can only be configured as external interrupt pins if their
external interrupt enable bit in the corresponding interrupt register has been set. The pin must also
be setup as an input by setting the corresponding bit in the port control register. When the interrupt
is enabled, the stack is not full and the correct transition type appears on the external interrupt pin,
a subroutine call to the external interrupt vector, will take place. When the interrupt is serviced, the
external interrupt request flags, INT0F~INT1F, will be automatically reset and the EMI bit will be
automatically cleared to disable other interrupts. Note that any pull-high resistor selections on the
external interrupt pins will remain valid even if the pin is used as an external interrupt input.
The INTEG register is used to select the type of active edge that will trigger the external interrupt.
A choice of either rising or falling or both edge types can be chosen to trigger an external interrupt.
Note that the INTEG register can also be used to disable the external interrupt function.
Multi-function Interrupt
Within this device there are up to three Multi-function interrupts. Unlike the other independent
interrupts, these interrupts have no independent source, but rather are formed from other existing
interrupt sources, namely the TM Interrupts, EEPROM Interrupt and LVD interrupt.
A Multi-function interrupt request will take place when any of the Multi-function interrupt request
flags, MFnF, are set. The Multi-function interrupt flags will be set when any of their included
functions generate an interrupt request flag. To allow the program to branch to its respective
interrupt vector address, when the Multi-function interrupt is enabled and the stack is not full, and
either one of the interrupts contained within each of Multi-function interrupt occurs, a subroutine
call to one of the Multi-function interrupt vectors will take place. When the interrupt is serviced, the
related Multi-Function request flag, will be automatically reset and the EMI bit will be automatically
cleared to disable other interrupts.
However, it must be noted that, although the Multi-function Interrupt flags will be automatically
reset when the interrupt is serviced, the request flags from the original source of the Multi-function
interrupts, namely the TM Interrupts, EEPROM Interrupt and LVD interrupt will not be
automatically reset and must be manually reset by the application program.
Rev. 1.00
166
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Time Base Interrupt
The function of the Time Base Interrupt is to provide regular time signal in the form of an internal
interrupt. It is controlled by the overflow signal from its internal timer. When this happens its
interrupt request flag, TBnF, will be set. To allow the program to branch to its respective interrupt
vector addresses, the global interrupt enable bit, EMI and Time Base enable bit, TBnE, must first be
set. When the interrupt is enabled, the stack is not full and the Time Base overflows, a subroutine
call to its respective vector location will take place. When the interrupt is serviced, the interrupt
request flag, TBnF, will be automatically reset and the EMI bit will be cleared to disable other
interrupts.
The purpose of the Time Base Interrupt is to provide an interrupt signal at fixed time periods. Its
clock source, fTB, originates from the internal clock source fSUB or fSYS/4. And then passes through
a divider, the division ratio of which is selected by programming the appropriate bits in the TBC
register to obtain longer interrupt periods whose value ranges. The clock source which in turn
controls the Time Base interrupt period is selected using a bit in the TBC register.
TBC Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
TBON
TBCK
TB11
TB10
LXTLP
TB02
TB01
TB00
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5~4
Bit 3
Bit 2~0
TBON: Time Base 0 and Time Base 1 Enable/Disable
0: Disable
1: Enable
TBCK: TB Clock fTB Select
0: fSUB
1: fSYS/4
TB11~TB10: Time Base 1 Time-out Period Selection
00: 212/fTB
01: 213/fTB
10: 214/fTB
11: 215/fTB
LXTLP: LXT Low Power Control
0: Disable (LXT quick start-up)
1: Enable (LXT low power start-up)
TB02~TB00: Time Base 0 Time-out Period
000: 28/fTB
001: 29/fTB
010: 210/fTB
011: 211/fTB
100: 212/fTB
101: 213/fTB
110: 214/fTB
111: 215/fTB
      Time Base Interrupt
Rev. 1.00
167
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
EEPROM Interrupt
The EEPROM interrupt is contained within the Multi-function Interrupt. An EEPROM Interrupt
request will take place when the EEPROM Interrupt request flag, DEF, is set, which occurs when
an EEPROM write operation ends. To allow the program to branch to its respective interrupt vector
address, the global interrupt enable bit, EMI, and the EEPROM Interrupt enable bit, DEE, and Mutifunction interrupt enable bits, must first be set. When the interrupt is enabled, the stack is not full
and an EEPROM write operation ends, a subroutine call to the respective Multi-function Interrupt
vector, will take place.When the EEPROM Interrupt is serviced, the EMI bit will be automatically
cleared to disable other interrupts, however only the Multi-function interrupt request flag will be
also automatically cleared. As the DEF flag will not be automatically cleared, it has to be cleared by
the application program.
LVD Interrupt
The Low Voltage Detector Interrupt is contained within the Multi-function Interrupt. An LVD
Interrupt request will take place when the LVD Interrupt request flag, LVF, is set, which occurs
when the Low Voltage Detector function detects a low power supply voltage. To allow the program
to branch to its respective interrupt vector address, the global interrupt enable bit, EMI, Low Voltage
Interrupt enable bit, LVE, and associated Multi-function interrupt enable bit, must first be set. When
the interrupt is enabled, the stack is not full and a low voltage condition occurs, a subroutine call to
the Multi-function Interrupt vector, will take place. When the Low Voltage Interrupt is serviced, the
EMI bit will be automatically cleared to disable other interrupts, however only the Multi-function
interrupt request flag will be also automatically cleared. As the LVF flag will not be automatically
cleared, it has to be cleared by the application program.
TM Interrupts
The Compact and Standard Type TMs have two interrupts each, while the Enhanced Type TM has
three interrupts. All of the TM interrupts are contained within the Multi-function Interrupts. For each
of the Compact and Standard Type TMs there are two interrupt request flags TnPF and TnAF and
two enable bits TnPE and TnAE. For the Enhanced Type TM there are three interrupt request flags
TnPF, TnAF and TnBF and three enable bits TnPE, TnAE and TnBE. A TM interrupt request will
take place when any of the TM request flags are set, a situation which occurs when a TM comparator
P, A or B match situation happens.
To allow the program to branch to its respective interrupt vector address, the global interrupt enable
bit, EMI, respective TM Interrupt enable bit, and relevant Multi-function Interrupt enable bit, MFnE,
must first be set. When the interrupt is enabled, the stack is not full and a TM comparator match
situation occurs, a subroutine call to the relevant Multi-function Interrupt vector locations, will take
place. When the TM interrupt is serviced, the EMI bit will be automatically cleared to disable other
interrupts, however only the related MFnF flag will be automatically cleared. As the TM interrupt
request flags will not be automatically cleared, they have to be cleared by the application program.
Rev. 1.00
168
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Interrupt Wake-up Function
Each of the interrupt functions has the capability of waking up the microcontroller when in the
SLEEP or IDLE Mode. A wake-up is generated when an interrupt request flag changes from low to
high and is independent of whether the interrupt is enabled or not. Therefore, even though the device
is in the SLEEP or IDLE Mode and its system oscillator stopped, situations such as external edge
transitions on the external interrupt pins, a low power supply voltage or comparator input change
may cause their respective interrupt flag to be set high and consequently generate an interrupt. Care
must therefore be taken if spurious wake-up situations are to be avoided. If an interrupt wake-up
function is to be disabled then the corresponding interrupt request flag should be set high before the
device enters the SLEEP or IDLE Mode. The interrupt enable bits have no effect on the interrupt
wake-up function.
Programming Considerations
By disabling the relevant interrupt enable bits, a requested interrupt can be prevented from being
serviced, however, once an interrupt request flag is set, it will remain in this condition in the
interrupt register until the corresponding interrupt is serviced or until the request flag is cleared by
the application program.
Where a certain interrupt is contained within a Multi-function interrupt, then when the interrupt
service routine is executed, as only the Multi-function interrupt request flags, MF0F~MF2F, will
be automatically cleared, the individual request flag for the function needs to be cleared by the
application program.
It is recommended that programs do not use the “CALL” instruction within the interrupt service
subroutine. Interrupts often occur in an unpredictable manner or need to be serviced immediately.
If only one stack is left and the interrupt is not well controlled, the original control sequence will be
damaged once a CALL subroutine is executed in the interrupt subroutine.
Every interrupt has the capability of waking up the microcontroller when it is in SLEEP or IDLE
Mode, the wake up being generated when the interrupt request flag changes from low to high. If it is
required to prevent a certain interrupt from waking up the microcontroller then its respective request
flag should be first set high before enter SLEEP or IDLE Mode.
As only the Program Counter is pushed onto the stack, then when the interrupt is serviced, if the
contents of the accumulator, status register or other registers are altered by the interrupt service
program, their contents should be saved to the memory at the beginning of the interrupt service
routine.
To return from an interrupt subroutine, either a RET or RETI instruction may be executed. The RETI
instruction in addition to executing a return to the main program also automatically sets the EMI
bit high to allow further interrupts. The RET instruction however only executes a return to the main
program leaving the EMI bit in its present zero state and therefore disabling the execution of further
interrupts.
Rev. 1.00
169
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Low Voltage Detector – LVD
Each device has a Low Voltage Detector function, also known as LVD. This enabled the device to
monitor the power supply voltage, VDD, and provide a warning signal should it fall below a certain
level. This function may be especially useful in battery applications where the supply voltage will
gradually reduce as the battery ages, as it allows an early warning battery low signal to be generated.
The Low Voltage Detector also has the capability of generating an interrupt signal.
LVD Register
The Low Voltage Detector function is controlled using a single register with the name LVDC. Three
bits in this register, VLVD2~VLVD0, are used to select one of eight fixed voltages below which a
low voltage condition will be detemined. A low voltage condition is indicated when the LVDO bit is
set. If the LVDO bit is low, this indicates that the VDD voltage is above the preset low voltage value.
The LVDEN bit is used to control the overall on/off function of the low voltage detector. Setting the
bit high will enable the low voltage detector. Clearing the bit to zero will switch off the internal low
voltage detector circuits. As the low voltage detector will consume a certain amount of power, it may
be desirable to switch off the circuit when not in use, an important consideration in power sensitive
battery powered applications.
LVDC Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
—
—
LVDO
LVDEN
—
VLVD2
VLVD1
VLVD0
R/W
—
—
R
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
—
—
0
0
—
0
0
0
Bit 7~6
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 5
LVDO: LVD Output Flag
0: No Low Voltage Detected
1: Low Voltage Detected
Bit 4
LVDEN: Low Voltage Detector Enable/Disable
0: Disable
1: Enable
Bit 3
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 2~0
VLVD2~VLVD0: Select LVD Voltage
000: 2.0V
001: 2.2V
010: 2.4V
011: 2.7V
100: 3.0V
101: 3.3V
110: 3.6V
111: 4.0V
170
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
LVD Operation
The Low Voltage Detector function operates by comparing the power supply voltage, VDD, with a
pre-specified voltage level stored in the LVDC register. This has a range of between 2.0V and 4.0V.
When the power supply voltage, VDD, falls below this pre-determined value, the LVDO bit will be
set high indicating a low power supply voltage condition. The Low Voltage Detector function is
supplied by a reference voltage which will be automatically enabled. When the device is powered
down the low voltage detector will remain active if the LVDEN bit is high. After enabling the Low
Voltage Detector, a time delay tLVDS should be allowed for the circuitry to stabilise before reading the
LVDO bit. Note also that as the VDD voltage may rise and fall rather slowly, at the voltage nears that
of VLVD, there may be multiple bit LVDO transitions.
LVD Operation
The Low Voltage Detector also has its own interrupt which is contained within one of the Multifunction interrupts, providing an alternative means of low voltage detection, in addition to polling
the LVDO bit. The interrupt will only be generated after a delay of tLVD after the LVDO bit has been
set high by a low voltage condition. When the device is powered down the Low Voltage Detector
will remain active if the LVDEN bit is high. In this case, the LVF interrupt request flag will be set,
causing an interrupt to be generated if VDD falls below the preset LVD voltage. This will cause the
device to wake-up from the SLEEP or IDLE Mode, however if the Low Voltage Detector wake up
function is not required then the LVF flag should be first set high before the device enters the SLEEP
or IDLE Mode.
When LVD function is enabled, it is recommended to clear LVD flag first, and then enables interrupt
function to avoid mistake action.
Rev. 1.00
171
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
LCD Driver
For large volume applications, which incorporate an LCD in their design, the use of a custom
display rather than a more expensive character based display reduces costs significantly. However,
the corresponding COM and SEG signals required, which vary in both amplitude and time, to drive
such a custom display require many special considerations for proper LCD operation to occur.
These devices all contain an LCD Driver function, which with their internal LCD signal generating
circuitry and various options, will automatically generate these time and amplitude varying signals
to provide a means of direct driving and easy interfacing to a range of custom LCDs.
All devices include a wide range of options to enable LCD displays of various types to be driven.
The table shows the range of options available across the device range.
Device
Duty
Bias
Bias Type
Wave Type
1/3 or 1/4
1/2 or 1/3
R or C
A or B
HT69F30A
HT69F40A
HT69F50A
LCD Selections
LCD Memory
An area of Data Memory is especially reserved for use for the LCD display data. This data area
is known as the LCD Memory. Any data written here will be automatically read by the internal
display driver circuits, which will in turn automatically generate the necessary LCD driving signals.
Therefore any data written into this Memory will be immediately reflected into the actual display
connected to the microcontroller.
As the LCD Memory addresses overlap those of the General Purpose Data Memory, it s stored in
its own independent Bank 1 area. The Data Memory Bank to be used is chosen by using the Bank
Pointer, which is a special function register in the Data Memory, with the name, BP. To access the
LCD Memory therefore requires first that Bank 1 is selected by writing a value of 01H to the BP
register. After this, the memory can then be accessed by using indirect addressing through the use
of Memory Pointer MP1. With Bank 1 selected, then using MP1 to read or write to the memory
area, starting with address “80H” for all the devices, will result in operations to the LCD Memory.
Directly addressing the Display Memory is not applicable and will result in a data access to the
Bank 0 General Purpose Data Memory.
The accompanying LCD Memory Map diagrams shows how the internal LCD Memory is mapped
to the Segments and Commons of the display for the devices. LCD Memory Maps for devices with
smaller memory capacities can be extrapolated from these diagrams.
Rev. 1.00
172
March 19, 2013
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
SEG21
95H
SEG21
96H
SEG22
96H
SEG22
97H
SEG23
97H
SEG23
98H
SEG24
: Unused, read as “0”
24 SEG x 4 COM
COM0
95H
B0
SEG1
COM1
81H
B1
SEG1
COM2
81H
COM0
SEG0
COM1
80H
COM2
SEG0
COM3
80H
25 SEG x 3 COM
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
HT69F30A LCD Memory Map
SEG1
A1H
SEG33
A1H
SEG33
A2H
SEG34
A2H
SEG34
A3H
SEG35
A3H
SEG35
A4H
SEG36
: Unused, read as “0"
36 SEG x 4 COM
COM0
81H
COM1
SEG1
COM2
81H
COM0
SEG0
COM1
80H
COM2
SEG0
COM3
80H
37 SEG x 3 COM
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
HT69F40A LCD Memory Map
SEG1
ADH
SEG45
ADH
SEG45
AEH
SEG46
AEH
SEG46
AFH
SEG47
AFH
SEG47
B0H
SEG48
: Unused, read as “0”
COM0
81H
COM1
SEG1
COM2
81H
COM0
SEG0
COM1
80H
COM2
SEG0
COM3
80H
49 SEG x 3 COM
48 SEG x 4 COM
HT69F50A LCD Memory Map
Rev. 1.00
173
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
LCD Register
There is one control register, named as LCDC, in the Data Memory used to control the various setup
features of the LCD Driver.
Various bits in this registers control functions such as LCD wave type, duty type, bias type, bias
resistor selection as well as overall LCD enable and disable. The LCDEN bit in the LCDC register,
which provides the overall LCD enable/disable function, will only be effective when the device is
in the NOAMRL, SLOW or IDLE Mode. If the device is in the SLEEP Mode then the display will
always be disabled. Bits, RSEL0 and RSEL1, in the LCDC register select the internal bias resistors
to supply the LCD panel with the correct bias voltages. A choice to best match the LCD panel used
in the application can be selected also to minimise bias current. The TYPE bit in the same register is
used to select whether Type A or Type B LCD control signals are used.
LCDC Register
Rev. 1.00
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
R/W
TYPE
—
DTYC
—
BIAS
RSEL1
RSEL0
LCDEN
R/W
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
POR
R/W
0
—
0
—
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
TYPE: LCD Wave Type Control
0: Type A
1: Type B
Bit 6
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 5
DTYC: LCD Duty Control
0: 1/3 duty
1: 1/4 duty
Bit 4
Unimplemented, read as “0”
Bit 3
BIAS: LCD Bias Control
0: 1/2 bias
1: 1/3 bias
Bit 2~1
RSEL1~RSEL0: LCD Bias Resistor Selection
1/3 Bias
00: 600kΩ
01: 300kΩ
10: 100kΩ
11: 50kΩ
1/2 Bias
00: 400kΩ
01: 200kΩ
10: 67kΩ
11: 34kΩ
Bit 0
LCDEN: LCD Enable Control
0: Disable
1: Enable
In the NORMAL, SLOW or IDLE mode, the LCD on/off function can be controlled
by this bit. in the SLEEP mode, the LCD function is always off.
174
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
LCD Reset Function
The LCD has an internal reset function that is an OR function of the inverted LCDEN bit in the
LCDC register and the Sleep function. When the LCDEN bit is set to 1 to enable the LCD driver
function before the device enters the SLEEP mode, the LCD function will be reset after the device
enters the SLEEP mode. Clearing the LCDEN bit to zero will also reset the LCD function.
LCDEN
SLEEP Mode
Reset LCD
0
Off
√
0
On
√
1
Off
x
1
On
√
LCD Reset Function
Clock Source
The LCD clock source is the internal clock signal, fSUB, divided by 8, using an internal divider
circuit. The fSUB internal clock is supplied by either the LIRC or LXT oscillator, the choice of which
is determined by a configuration option. For proper LCD operation, this arrangement is provided to
generate an ideal LCD clock source frequency of 4kHz.
fSUB Clock Source
LCD Clock Frequency
LIRC
4kHz
LXT
4kHz
LCD Clock Source
LCD Driver Output
The number of COM and SEG outputs supplied by the LCD driver, as well as its biasing and duty
selections, are dependent upon how the LCD control bits are programmed. The Bias Type, whether
C or R type is selected via a configuration option.
The nature of Liquid Crystal Displays require that only AC voltages can be applied to their pixels
as the application of DC voltages to LCD pixels may cause permanent damage. For this reason the
relative contrast of an LCD display is controlled by the actual RMS voltage applied to each pixel,
which is equal to the RMS value of the voltage on the COM pin minus the voltage applied to the
SEG pin. This differential RMS voltage must be greater than the LCD saturation voltage for the
pixel to be on and less than the threshold voltage for the pixel to be off.
The requirement to limit the DC voltage to zero and to control as many pixels as possible with
a minimum number of connections, requires that both a time and amplitude signal is generated
and applied to the application LCD. These time and amplitude varying signals are automatically
generated by the LCD driver circuits in the microcontroller. What is known as the duty determines
the number of common lines used, which are also known as backplanes or COMs. The duty, which
is chosen by a control bit to have a value of 1/3 or 1/4 and which equates to a COM number of 3
or 4 respectively, therefore defines the number of time divisions within each LCD signal frame.
Two types of signal generation are also provided, known as Type A and Type B, the required type
is selected via the TYPE bit in the LCDC register. Type B offers lower frequency signals, however
lower frequencies may introduce flickering and influence display clarity.
Rev. 1.00
175
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
LCD Voltage Source Biasing
The time and amplitude varying signals generated by the LCD Driver function require the generation
of several voltage levels for their operation. The number of voltage levels used by the signal depends
upon the value of the BIAS bit in the LCDC register. The device can have either R type or C type
biasing selected via a configuration option. Selecting the C type biasing will enable an internal
charge pump whose multiplier ratio can be selected using an additional configuration option.
For R type biasing an external LCD voltage source must be supplied on pin VLCD to generate the
internal biasing voltages. This could be the microcontroller power supply or some other voltage
source. For the R type 1/2 bias selection, three voltage levels VSS, VA and VB are utilised. The
voltage VA is equal to the externally supplied voltage source applied to pin VLCD. The voltage VB is
generated internally by the microcontroller and will have a value equal to VLCD/2. For the R type 1/3
bias selection, four voltage levels VSS, VA, VB and VC are utilised. The voltage VA is equal to VLCD. The
voltage VB is equal to VLCD×2/3 while the voltage VC is equal to VLCD×1/3. In addition to selecting 1/2
or 1/3 bias, several values of bias resistor can be chosen using bits in the LCDC register.
Different values of internal bias resistors can be selected using the RSEL0 and RESEL1 bits in
the LCDC register. This along with the voltage on pin VLCD will determine the bias current. The
connection to the VMAX pin depends upon the voltage that is applied to the VLCD pin. If the VDD
voltage is greater than the voltage applied to the VLCD pin then the VMAX pin should be connected
to VDD, otherwise the VMAX pin should be connected to pin VLCD. Note that no external
capacitors or resistors are required to be connected if R type biasing is used.
Condition
VMAX connection
VDD > VLCD
Connect VMAX to VDD
Otherwise
Connect VMAX to VLCD
R Type Bias VMAX Pin Connection
For C type biasing an external LCD voltage source must also be supplied on pin VLCD to generate
the internal biasing voltages. The C type biasing scheme uses an internal charge pump circuit, which
in the case of the 1/3 bias selection, can generate voltages higher than what is supplied on VLCD.
This feature is useful in applications where the microcontroller supply voltage is less than the supply
voltage required by the LCD. An additional charge pump capacitor must also be connected between
pins C1 and C2 to generate the necessary voltage levels.
For the C type 1/2 bias selection, three voltage levels VSS, VA and VB are utilised. The voltage VA is
generated internally and has a value of VLCD. The voltage VB will have a value equal to VA×1/2. For
the C type 1/2 bias configuration VC is not used.
For the C type 1/3 bias selection, four voltage levels VSS, VA, VB and VC are utilised. The voltage
VA is generated internally and has a value of VLCD×3/2. The voltage VB will have a value equal to
VA×2/3 and VC will have a value equal to VA×1/3. The connection to the VMAX pin depends upon
the bias and the voltage that is applied to VLCD. It is extremely important to ensure that these
charge pump generated internal voltages do not exceed the maximum VDD voltage of 5.5V.
Biasing Type
1/3 Bias
1/2 Bias
VMAX Connection
VDD>VLCD×1.5
Connect VMAX to VDD
Otherwise
Connect VMAX to V1
VDD>VLCD
Connect VMAX to VDD
Otherwise
Connect VMAX to VLCD
C Type Bias VMAX Pin Connection
Rev. 1.00
176
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
LCD Waveform Timing Diagram
The accompanying timing diagrams depict the display driver signals generated by the
microcontroller for various values of duty and bias. The huge range of various permutations only
permits a few types to be displayed here.
D u r in g R e s e t o r L C D
F u n c tio n is s w itc h e d o ff
 F u n c tio n in N o r m a l O p e r a tio n M o d e
  L C D
 LCD Driver Output – Type A- 1/3 Duty, 1/2 Bias
Note: For 1/2 Bias, the VA=VLCD, VB=VLCD×1/2 for both R and C type.
Rev. 1.00
177
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
D u r in g R e s e t o r L C D
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
F u n c tio n is s w itc h e d o ff
     L C D
  
 
    F u n c tio n in N o r m a l O p e r a tio n M o d e
     LCD Driver Output – Type A - 1/4 Duty, 1/3 Bias
Note: For 1/3 R type bias, the VA=VLCD, VB=VLCD×2/3 and VC=VLCD×1/3.
For 1/3 C type bias, the VA=VLCD×1.5, VB=VLCD and VC=VLCD×1/2.
Rev. 1.00
178
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
D u r in g R e s e t o r L C D
F u n c tio n is s w itc h e d o ff
      L C D
  F u n c tio n in N o r m a l O p e r a tio n M o d e
LCD Driver Output – Type A- 1/3 Duty, 1/3 Bias
Note: For 1/3 R type bias, the VA=VLCD, VB=VLCD×2/3 and VC=VLCD×1/3.
For 1/3 C type bias, VA=VLCD×1.5, VB=VLCD and VC=VLCD×1/2.
Rev. 1.00
179
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
During Reset or LCD Off
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
COM0, COM1, COM2
All segment outputs
1 Frame
Normal Operation Mode
VA
VB
VC
VSS
COM0
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
COM1
COM2
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
All segments are OFF
COM0 side segments are ON
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
COM1 side segments are ON
COM2 side segments are ON
COM0, 1 side segments are ON
VA
VB
VC
VSS
COM0, 2 side segments are ON
(other combinations are omitted)
VA
VB
VC
VSS
All segments are ON
LCD Driver Output – Type B- 1/3 Duty, 1/3 Bias
Note: For 1/3 R type bias, the VA=VLCD, VB=VLCD×2/3 and VC=VLCD×1/3.
For 1/3 C type bias, VA=VLCD×3/2, VB=VLCD and VC=VLCD×1/2.
Rev. 1.00
180
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
D u r in g R e s e t o r L C D
F u n c tio n is s w itc h e d o ff
During Reset or LCD Off
  CO�0�
 CO�1�
 CO���
 CO��
     All segment outputs
L C D
F u n Normal
c t i o n i n Operation
N o r m a l O Mode
p e r a tio n M o d e

VA
VB
VC
VSS

VA
VB
VC
VSS
  1 F�ame


VA
VB
VC
VSS
CO�0
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
CO�1
CO��
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC
VSS
VA
VB
VC VSS
All segments a�e OFF
CO�0 side segments a�e ON
CO�1 side segments a�e ON
CO�� side segments a�e ON
CO�� side segments a�e ON
CO�0� 1 side segments a�e ON
 CO�0� � side segments a�e ON
 CO�0� � side segments a�e ON
(ot�e�
 �ombinations
a�e omitted)
All
segments
a�e
ON
VA
VB
VC
VSS
CO��
VA
VB
VC
VSS
LCD Driver Output – Type B- 1/4 Duty, 1/3 Bias
Note: For 1/3 R type bias, the VA=VLCD, VB=VLCD×2/3 and VC=VLCD×1/3.
For 1/3 C type bias, VA=VLCD×3/2, VB=VLCD and VC=VLCD×1/2.
Rev. 1.00
181
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Programming Considerations
Certain precautions must be taken when programming the LCD. One of these is to ensure that
the LCD Memory is properly initialised after the microcontroller is powered on. Like the General
Purpose Data Memory, the contents of the LCD Memory are in an unknown condition after
power-on. As the contents of the LCD Memory will be mapped into the actual display, it is important
to initialise this memory area into a known condition soon after applying power to obtain a proper
display pattern.
Consideration must also be given to the capacitive load of the actual LCD used in the application.
As the load presented to the microcontroller by LCD pixels can be generally modeled as mainly
capacitive in nature, it is important that this is not excessive, a point that is particularly true in the
case of the COM lines which may be connected to many LCD pixels. The accompanying diagram
depicts the equivalent circuit of the LCD.
One additional consideration that must be taken into account is what happens when the
microcontroller enters the Idle or Slow Mode. The LCDEN control bit in the LCDC register permits
the display to be powered off to reduce power consumption. If this bit is zero, the driving signals
to the display will cease, producing a blank display pattern but reducing any power consumption
associated with the LCD.
After Power-on, note that as the LCDEN bit will be cleared to zero, the display function will be
disabled.
LCD Panel Equivalent Circuit
Rev. 1.00
182
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Configuration Options
Configuration options refer to certain options within the MCU that are programmed into the device
during the programming process. During the development process, these options are selected using
the HT-IDE software development tools. As these options are programmed into the device using
the hardware programming tools, once they are selected they cannot be changed later using the
application program. All options must be defined for proper system function, the details of which are
shown in the table.
No.
Options
1
High Speed System Oscillator Selection – fH
HXT, ERC, EC or HIRC
2
HXT Mode Selection
1MHz~12MHz or 455kHz
3
Low Speed System Oscillator Selection – fL
LXT or LIRC
4
HIRC Frequency Selection
4MHz, 8MHz or 12MHz
5
LCD Bias Type Selection
R type or C type
6
LCD Voltage Selection
VLCD voltage is 3.0V, 4.5V or 1.5V
7
TMR/INT Pin Input Filter Function
Enable or Disable
8
I/O or Reset pin selection
Reset pin or I/O pin
9
Watchdog Timer Function
Always enable or Application program enable
Note: The fSUB clock source is derived from LXT or LIRC selected by the fL configuration option.
Rev. 1.00
183
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Application Circuits
COM[3:0]
SEG[47:0]
VLCD
VMAX
VDD
VDD
100KΩ
C1
PA7/RES
0.1uF
LCD
Panel
0.1uF
C2
V1
0.1uF
VSS
0.1uF
V2
0.1uF
OSC
Circuit
PB0/OSC1
OSC
Circuit
PB2/XT1
PB1/OSC2
PA0/INT1/TCK1
PA1/TP0_1
PA2/TCK0/TCK2
PA3/TP2_0
PA4/INT0
PA5/TP2_1
PA6/TP0_0
PB3/XT2
PB4/TP1A
PB5/TP1B_0
PB6/TP1B_1
PB7/TP1B_2
PC3~PC6
PD0~PD7
PE0~PE7
PF0~PF7
PG0~PG7
PH0~PH7
Rev. 1.00
184
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Instruction Set
Introduction
Central to the successful operation of any microcontroller is its instruction set, which is a set of
program instruction codes that directs the microcontroller to perform certain operations. In the case
of Holtek microcontrollers, a comprehensive and flexible set of over 60 instructions is provided to
enable programmers to implement their application with the minimum of programming overheads.
For easier understanding of the various instruction codes, they have been subdivided into several
functional groupings.
Instruction Timing
Most instructions are implemented within one instruction cycle. The exceptions to this are branch,
call, or table read instructions where two instruction cycles are required. One instruction cycle is
equal to 4 system clock cycles, therefore in the case of an 8MHz system oscillator, most instructions
would be implemented within 0.5µs and branch or call instructions would be implemented within
1µs. Although instructions which require one more cycle to implement are generally limited to
the JMP, CALL, RET, RETI and table read instructions, it is important to realize that any other
instructions which involve manipulation of the Program Counter Low register or PCL will also take
one more cycle to implement. As instructions which change the contents of the PCL will imply a
direct jump to that new address, one more cycle will be required. Examples of such instructions
would be ″CLR PCL″ or ″MOV PCL, A″. For the case of skip instructions, it must be noted that if
the result of the comparison involves a skip operation then this will also take one more cycle, if no
skip is involved then only one cycle is required.
Moving and Transferring Data
The transfer of data within the microcontroller program is one of the most frequently used
operations. Making use of three kinds of MOV instructions, data can be transferred from registers to
the Accumulator and vice-versa as well as being able to move specific immediate data directly into
the Accumulator. One of the most important data transfer applications is to receive data from the
input ports and transfer data to the output ports.
Arithmetic Operations
The ability to perform certain arithmetic operations and data manipulation is a necessary feature of
most microcontroller applications. Within the Holtek microcontroller instruction set are a range of
add and subtract instruction mnemonics to enable the necessary arithmetic to be carried out. Care
must be taken to ensure correct handling of carry and borrow data when results exceed 255 for
addition and less than 0 for subtraction. The increment and decrement instructions INC, INCA, DEC
and DECA provide a simple means of increasing or decreasing by a value of one of the values in the
destination specified.
Rev. 1.00
185
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Logical and Rotate Operations
The standard logical operations such as AND, OR, XOR and CPL all have their own instruction
within the Holtek microcontroller instruction set. As with the case of most instructions involving
data manipulation, data must pass through the Accumulator which may involve additional
programming steps. In all logical data operations, the zero flag may be set if the result of the
operation is zero. Another form of logical data manipulation comes from the rotate instructions such
as RR, RL, RRC and RLC which provide a simple means of rotating one bit right or left. Different
rotate instructions exist depending on program requirements. Rotate instructions are useful for serial
port programming applications where data can be rotated from an internal register into the Carry
bit from where it can be examined and the necessary serial bit set high or low. Another application
where rotate data operations are used is to implement multiplication and division calculations.
Branches and Control Transfer
Program branching takes the form of either jumps to specified locations using the JMP instruction or
to a subroutine using the CALL instruction. They differ in the sense that in the case of a subroutine
call, the program must return to the instruction immediately when the subroutine has been carried
out. This is done by placing a return instruction RET in the subroutine which will cause the program
to jump back to the address right after the CALL instruction. In the case of a JMP instruction, the
program simply jumps to the desired location. There is no requirement to jump back to the original
jumping off point as in the case of the CALL instruction. One special and extremely useful set
of branch instructions are the conditional branches. Here a decision is first made regarding the
condition of a certain data memory or individual bits. Depending upon the conditions, the program
will continue with the next instruction or skip over it and jump to the following instruction. These
instructions are the key to decision making and branching within the program perhaps determined
by the condition of certain input switches or by the condition of internal data bits.
Bit Operations
The ability to provide single bit operations on Data Memory is an extremely flexible feature of all
Holtek microcontrollers. This feature is especially useful for output port bit programming where
individual bits or port pins can be directly set high or low using either the ″SET [m].i″ or ″CLR [m].i″
instructions respectively. The feature removes the need for programmers to first read the 8-bit output
port, manipulate the input data to ensure that other bits are not changed and then output the port with
the correct new data. This read-modify-write process is taken care of automatically when these bit
operation instructions are used.
Table Read Operations
Data storage is normally implemented by using registers. However, when working with large
amounts of fixed data, the volume involved often makes it inconvenient to store the fixed data in
the Data Memory. To overcome this problem, Holtek microcontrollers allow an area of Program
Memory to be setup as a table where data can be directly stored. A set of easy to use instructions
provides the means by which this fixed data can be referenced and retrieved from the Program
Memory.
Other Operations
In addition to the above functional instructions, a range of other instructions also exist such as
the ″HALT″ instruction for Power-down operations and instructions to control the operation of
the Watchdog Timer for reliable program operations under extreme electric or electromagnetic
environments. For their relevant operations, refer to the functional related sections.
Rev. 1.00
186
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Instruction Set Summary
The following table depicts a summary of the instruction set categorised according to function and
can be consulted as a basic instruction reference using the following listed conventions.
Table conventions
x: Bits immediate data
m: Data Memory address
A: Accumulator
i: 0~7 number of bits
addr: Program memory address
Mnemonic
Description
Cycles
Flag Affected
ADD A,[m]
ADDM A,[m]
ADD A,x
ADC A,[m]
ADCM A,[m]
SUB A,x
SUB A,[m]
SUBM A,[m]
SBC A,[m]
SBCM A,[m]
DAA [m]
Logic Operation
Add Data Memory to ACC
Add ACC to Data Memory
Add immediate data to ACC
Add Data Memory to ACC with Carry
Add ACC to Data memory with Carry
Subtract immediate data from the ACC
Subtract Data Memory from ACC
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with result in Data Memory
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with Carry
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with Carry, result in Data Memory
Decimal adjust ACC for Addition with result in Data Memory
1
1Note
1
1
1Note
1
1
1Note
1
1Note
1Note
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
Z, C, AC, OV
C
AND A,[m]
OR A,[m]
XOR A,[m]
ANDM A,[m]
ORM A,[m]
XORM A,[m]
AND A,x
OR A,x
XOR A,x
CPL [m]
CPLA [m]
Logical AND Data Memory to ACC
Logical OR Data Memory to ACC
Logical XOR Data Memory to ACC
Logical AND ACC to Data Memory
Logical OR ACC to Data Memory
Logical XOR ACC to Data Memory
Logical AND immediate Data to ACC
Logical OR immediate Data to ACC
Logical XOR immediate Data to ACC
Complement Data Memory
Complement Data Memory with result in ACC
1
1
1
1Note
1Note
1Note
1
1
1
1Note
1
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Arithmetic
Increment & Decrement
INCA [m]
INC [m]
DECA [m]
DEC [m]
Increment Data Memory with result in ACC
Increment Data Memory
Decrement Data Memory with result in ACC
Decrement Data Memory
1
1Note
1
1Note
Z
Z
Z
Z
Rotate
RRA [m]
RR [m]
RRCA [m]
RRC [m]
RLA [m]
RL [m]
RLCA [m]
RLC [m]
Rotate Data Memory right with result in ACC
Rotate Data Memory right
Rotate Data Memory right through Carry with result in ACC
Rotate Data Memory right through Carry
Rotate Data Memory left with result in ACC
Rotate Data Memory left
Rotate Data Memory left through Carry with result in ACC
Rotate Data Memory left through Carry
1
1Note
1
1Note
1
1Note
1
1Note
None
None
C
C
None
None
C
C
Rev. 1.00
187
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
Mnemonic
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Description
Cycles
Flag Affected
Move Data Memory to ACC
Move ACC to Data Memory
Move immediate data to ACC
1
1Note
1
None
None
None
Clear bit of Data Memory
Set bit of Data Memory
1Note
1Note
None
None
Jump unconditionally
Skip if Data Memory is zero
Skip if Data Memory is zero with data movement to ACC
Skip if bit i of Data Memory is zero
Skip if bit i of Data Memory is not zero
Skip if increment Data Memory is zero
Skip if decrement Data Memory is zero
Skip if increment Data Memory is zero with result in ACC
Skip if decrement Data Memory is zero with result in ACC
Subroutine call
Return from subroutine
Return from subroutine and load immediate data to ACC
Return from interrupt
2
1Note
1Note
1Note
1Note
1Note
1Note
1Note
1Note
2
2
2
2
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
Read table (current page) to TBLH and Data Memory
Read table (last page) to TBLH and Data Memory
2Note
2Note
None
None
No operation
Clear Data Memory
Set Data Memory
Clear Watchdog Timer
Pre-clear Watchdog Timer
Pre-clear Watchdog Timer
Swap nibbles of Data Memory
Swap nibbles of Data Memory with result in ACC
Enter power down mode
1
1Note
1Note
1
1
1
1Note
1
1
None
None
None
TO, PDF
TO, PDF
TO, PDF
None
None
TO, PDF
Data Move
MOV A,[m]
MOV [m],A
MOV A,x
Bit Operation
CLR [m].i
SET [m].i
Branch
JMP addr
SZ [m]
SZA [m]
SZ [m].i
SNZ [m].i
SIZ [m]
SDZ [m]
SIZA [m]
SDZA [m]
CALL addr
RET
RET A,x
RETI
Table Read
TABRDC [m]
TABRDL [m]
Miscellaneous
NOP
CLR [m]
SET [m]
CLR WDT
CLR WDT1
CLR WDT2
SWAP [m]
SWAPA [m]
HALT
Note: 1. For skip instructions, if the result of the comparison involves a skip then two cycles are required, if no
skip takes place only one cycle is required.
2. Any instruction which changes the contents of the PCL will also require 2 cycles for execution.
3. For the "CLR WDT1" and "CLR WDT2" instructions the TO and PDF flags may be affected by the
execution status. The TO and PDF flags are cleared after both "CLR WDT1" and "CLR WDT2"
instructions are consecutively executed. Otherwise the TO and PDF flags remain unchanged.
Rev. 1.00
188
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Instruction Definition
ADC A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
ADCM A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
ADD A,[m]
Description
Add Data Memory to ACC with Carry
The contents of the specified Data Memory, Accumulator and the carry flag are added.
The result is stored in the Accumulator.
ACC ← ACC + [m] + C
OV, Z, AC, C
Add ACC to Data Memory with Carry
The contents of the specified Data Memory, Accumulator and the carry flag are added.
The result is stored in the specified Data Memory.
[m] ← ACC + [m] + C
OV, Z, AC, C
Add Data Memory to ACC
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator are added.
The result is stored in the Accumulator.
Operation
Affected flag(s)
ACC ← ACC + [m]
OV, Z, AC, C
ADD A,x
Description
Add immediate data to ACC
The contents of the Accumulator and the specified immediate data are added.
The result is stored in the Accumulator.
ACC ← ACC + x
OV, Z, AC, C
Operation
Affected flag(s)
ADDM A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
AND A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
AND A,x
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
ANDM A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Rev. 1.00
Add ACC to Data Memory
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator are added.
The result is stored in the specified Data Memory.
[m] ← ACC + [m]
OV, Z, AC, C
Logical AND Data Memory to ACC
Data in the Accumulator and the specified Data Memory perform a bitwise logical AND
operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
ACC ← ACC ″AND″ [m]
Z
Logical AND immediate data to ACC
Data in the Accumulator and the specified immediate data perform a bit wise logical AND
operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
ACC ← ACC ″AND″ x
Z
Logical AND ACC to Data Memory
Data in the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator perform a bitwise logical AND
operation. The result is stored in the Data Memory.
[m] ← ACC ″AND″ [m]
Z
189
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Affected flag(s)
Subroutine call
Unconditionally calls a subroutine at the specified address. The Program Counter then
increments by 1 to obtain the address of the next instruction which is then pushed onto the
stack. The specified address is then loaded and the program continues execution from this
new address. As this instruction requires an additional operation, it is a two cycle instruction.
Stack ← Program Counter + 1
Program Counter ← addr
None
CLR [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Clear Data Memory
Each bit of the specified Data Memory is cleared to 0.
[m] ← 00H
None
CLR [m].i
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Clear bit of Data Memory
Bit i of the specified Data Memory is cleared to 0.
[m].i ← 0
None
CLR WDT
Description
Operation
Clear Watchdog Timer
The TO, PDF flags and the WDT are all cleared.
WDT cleared
TO ← 0
PDF ← 0
TO, PDF
CALL addr
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
CLR WDT1
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
CLR WDT2
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
CPL [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Rev. 1.00
Pre-clear Watchdog Timer
The TO, PDF flags and the WDT are all cleared. Note that this instruction works in
conjunction with CLR WDT2 and must be executed alternately with CLR WDT2 to have
effect. Repetitively executing this instruction without alternately executing CLR WDT2 will
have no effect.
WDT cleared
TO ← 0
PDF ← 0
TO, PDF
Pre-clear Watchdog Timer
The TO, PDF flags and the WDT are all cleared. Note that this instruction works in conjunction
with CLR WDT1 and must be executed alternately with CLR WDT1 to have effect.
Repetitively executing this instruction without alternately executing CLR WDT1 will have no
effect.
WDT cleared
TO ← 0
PDF ← 0
TO, PDF
Complement Data Memory
Each bit of the specified Data Memory is logically complemented (1′s complement). Bits which
previously contained a 1 are changed to 0 and vice versa.
[m] ← [m]
Z
190
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
CPLA [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Complement Data Memory with result in ACC
Each bit of the specified Data Memory is logically complemented (1′s complement). Bits which
previously contained a 1 are changed to 0 and vice versa. The complemented result is stored in
the Accumulator and the contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
ACC ← [m]
Z
Affected flag(s)
Decimal-Adjust ACC for addition with result in Data Memory
Convert the contents of the Accumulator value to a BCD (Binary Coded Decimal) value
resulting from the previous addition of two BCD variables. If the low nibble is greater than 9
or if AC flag is set, then a value of 6 will be added to the low nibble. Otherwise the low nibble
remains unchanged. If the high nibble is greater than 9 or if the C flag is set, then a value of 6
will be added to the high nibble. Essentially, the decimal conversion is performed by adding
00H, 06H, 60H or 66H depending on the Accumulator and flag conditions. Only the C flag
may be affected by this instruction which indicates that if the original BCD sum is greater than
100, it allows multiple precision decimal addition.
[m] ← ACC + 00H or
[m] ← ACC + 06H or
[m] ← ACC + 60H or
[m] ← ACC + 66H
C
DEC [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Decrement Data Memory
Data in the specified Data Memory is decremented by 1.
[m] ← [m] − 1
Z
DECA [m]
Description
Decrement Data Memory with result in ACC
Data in the specified Data Memory is decremented by 1. The result is stored in the
Accumulator. The contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
ACC ← [m] − 1
Z
DAA [m]
Description
Operation
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Affected flag(s)
Enter power down mode
This instruction stops the program execution and turns off the system clock. The contents of
the Data Memory and registers are retained. The WDT and prescaler are cleared. The power
down flag PDF is set and the WDT time-out flag TO is cleared.
TO ← 0
PDF ← 1
TO, PDF
INC [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Increment Data Memory
Data in the specified Data Memory is incremented by 1.
[m] ← [m] + 1
Z
INCA [m]
Description
Increment Data Memory with result in ACC
Data in the specified Data Memory is incremented by 1. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
The contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
ACC ← [m] + 1
Z
HALT
Description
Operation
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Rev. 1.00
191
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Jump unconditionally
The contents of the Program Counter are replaced with the specified address. Program
execution then continues from this new address. As this requires the insertion of a dummy
instruction while the new address is loaded, it is a two cycle instruction.
Program Counter ← addr
None
MOV A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Move Data Memory to ACC
The contents of the specified Data Memory are copied to the Accumulator.
ACC ← [m]
None
MOV A,x
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Move immediate data to ACC
The immediate data specified is loaded into the Accumulator.
ACC ← x
None
MOV [m],A
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Move ACC to Data Memory
The contents of the Accumulator are copied to the specified Data Memory.
[m] ← ACC
None
NOP
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
No operation
No operation is performed. Execution continues with the next instruction.
No operation
None
OR A,[m]
Description
Logical OR Data Memory to ACC
Data in the Accumulator and the specified Data Memory perform a bitwise
logical OR operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
ACC ← ACC ″OR″ [m]
Z
JMP addr
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
OR A,x
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
ORM A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
RET
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Rev. 1.00
Logical OR immediate data to ACC
Data in the Accumulator and the specified immediate data perform a bitwise logical OR
operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
ACC ← ACC ″OR″ x
Z
Logical OR ACC to Data Memory
Data in the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator perform a bitwise logical OR
operation. The result is stored in the Data Memory.
[m] ← ACC ″OR″ [m]
Z
Return from subroutine
The Program Counter is restored from the stack. Program execution continues at the restored
address.
Program Counter ← Stack
None
192
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
RET A,x
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
RETI
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
RL [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
RLA [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
RLC [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
RLCA [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
RR [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Rev. 1.00
Return from subroutine and load immediate data to ACC
The Program Counter is restored from the stack and the Accumulator loaded with the specified
immediate data. Program execution continues at the restored address.
Program Counter ← Stack
ACC ← x
None
Return from interrupt
The Program Counter is restored from the stack and the interrupts are re-enabled by setting the
EMI bit. EMI is the master interrupt global enable bit. If an interrupt was pending when the
RETI instruction is executed, the pending Interrupt routine will be processed before returning
to the main program.
Program Counter ← Stack
EMI ← 1
None
Rotate Data Memory left
The contents of the specified Data Memory are rotated left by 1 bit with bit 7 rotated into bit 0.
[m].(i+1) ← [m].i; (i=0~6)
[m].0 ← [m].7
None
Rotate Data Memory left with result in ACC
The contents of the specified Data Memory are rotated left by 1 bit with bit 7 rotated into bit 0.
The rotated result is stored in the Accumulator and the contents of the Data Memory remain
unchanged.
ACC.(i+1) ← [m].i; (i=0~6)
ACC.0 ← [m].7
None
Rotate Data Memory left through Carry
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated left by 1 bit. Bit 7
replaces the Carry bit and the original carry flag is rotated into bit 0.
[m].(i+1) ← [m].i; (i=0~6)
[m].0 ← C
C ← [m].7
C
Rotate Data Memory left through Carry with result in ACC
Data in the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated left by 1 bit. Bit 7 replaces the
Carry bit and the original carry flag is rotated into the bit 0. The rotated result is stored in the
Accumulator and the contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
ACC.(i+1) ← [m].i; (i=0~6)
ACC.0 ← C
C ← [m].7
C
Rotate Data Memory right
The contents of the specified Data Memory are rotated right by 1 bit with bit 0 rotated into bit 7.
[m].i ← [m].(i+1); (i=0~6)
[m].7 ← [m].0
None
193
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
RRA [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
RRC [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
RRCA [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
SBC A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
SBCM A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
SDZ [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Rev. 1.00
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Rotate Data Memory right with result in ACC
Data in the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated right by 1 bit with bit 0
rotated into bit 7. The rotated result is stored in the Accumulator and the contents of the
Data Memory remain unchanged.
ACC.i ← [m].(i+1); (i=0~6)
ACC.7 ← [m].0
None
Rotate Data Memory right through Carry
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated right by 1 bit. Bit 0
replaces the Carry bit and the original carry flag is rotated into bit 7.
[m].i ← [m].(i+1); (i=0~6)
[m].7 ← C
C ← [m].0
C
Rotate Data Memory right through Carry with result in ACC
Data in the specified Data Memory and the carry flag are rotated right by 1 bit. Bit 0 replaces
the Carry bit and the original carry flag is rotated into bit 7. The rotated result is stored in the
Accumulator and the contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
ACC.i ← [m].(i+1); (i=0~6)
ACC.7 ← C
C ← [m].0
C
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with Carry
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the complement of the carry flag are
subtracted from the Accumulator. The result is stored in the Accumulator. Note that if the
result of subtraction is negative, the C flag will be cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is
positive or zero, the C flag will be set to 1.
ACC ← ACC − [m] − C
OV, Z, AC, C
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with Carry and result in Data Memory
The contents of the specified Data Memory and the complement of the carry flag are
subtracted from the Accumulator. The result is stored in the Data Memory. Note that if the
result of subtraction is negative, the C flag will be cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is
positive or zero, the C flag will be set to 1.
[m] ← ACC − [m] − C
OV, Z, AC, C
Skip if decrement Data Memory is 0
The contents of the specified Data Memory are first decremented by 1. If the result is 0 the
following instruction is skipped. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while
the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not 0 the program
proceeds with the following instruction.
[m] ← [m] − 1
Skip if [m]=0
None
194
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Affected flag(s)
Skip if decrement Data Memory is zero with result in ACC
The contents of the specified Data Memory are first decremented by 1. If the result is 0, the
following instruction is skipped. The result is stored in the Accumulator but the specified
Data Memory contents remain unchanged. As this requires the insertion of a dummy
instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not 0,
the program proceeds with the following instruction.
ACC ← [m] − 1
Skip if ACC=0
None
SET [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Set Data Memory
Each bit of the specified Data Memory is set to 1.
[m] ← FFH
None
SET [m].i
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Set bit of Data Memory
Bit i of the specified Data Memory is set to 1.
[m].i ← 1
None
SIZ [m]
Description
Skip if increment Data Memory is 0
The contents of the specified Data Memory are first incremented by 1. If the result is 0, the
following instruction is skipped. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while
the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not 0 the program
proceeds with the following instruction.
[m] ← [m] + 1
Skip if [m]=0
None
SDZA [m]
Description
Operation
Operation
Affected flag(s)
SIZA [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
SNZ [m].i
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
SUB A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Rev. 1.00
Skip if increment Data Memory is zero with result in ACC
The contents of the specified Data Memory are first incremented by 1. If the result is 0, the
following instruction is skipped. The result is stored in the Accumulator but the specified
Data Memory contents remain unchanged. As this requires the insertion of a dummy
instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not
0 the program proceeds with the following instruction.
ACC ← [m] + 1
Skip if ACC=0
None
Skip if bit i of Data Memory is not 0
If bit i of the specified Data Memory is not 0, the following instruction is skipped. As this
requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two
cycle instruction. If the result is 0 the program proceeds with the following instruction.
Skip if [m].i ≠ 0
None
Subtract Data Memory from ACC
The specified Data Memory is subtracted from the contents of the Accumulator. The result is
stored in the Accumulator. Note that if the result of subtraction is negative, the C flag will be
cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is positive or zero, the C flag will be set to 1.
ACC ← ACC − [m]
OV, Z, AC, C
195
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
SUBM A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Subtract Data Memory from ACC with result in Data Memory
The specified Data Memory is subtracted from the contents of the Accumulator. The result is
stored in the Data Memory. Note that if the result of subtraction is negative, the C flag will be
cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is positive or zero, the C flag will be set to 1.
[m] ← ACC − [m]
OV, Z, AC, C
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Subtract immediate data from ACC
The immediate data specified by the code is subtracted from the contents of the Accumulator.
The result is stored in the Accumulator. Note that if the result of subtraction is negative, the C
flag will be cleared to 0, otherwise if the result is positive or zero, the C flag will be set to 1.
ACC ← ACC − x
OV, Z, AC, C
SWAP [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Swap nibbles of Data Memory
The low-order and high-order nibbles of the specified Data Memory are interchanged.
[m].3~[m].0 ↔ [m].7~[m].4
None
SWAPA [m]
Description
Swap nibbles of Data Memory with result in ACC
The low-order and high-order nibbles of the specified Data Memory are interchanged. The
result is stored in the Accumulator. The contents of the Data Memory remain unchanged.
ACC.3~ACC.0 ← [m].7~[m].4
ACC.7~ACC.4 ← [m].3~[m].0
None
SUB A,x
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
SZ [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
SZA [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
SZ [m].i
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Rev. 1.00
Skip if Data Memory is 0
If the contents of the specified Data Memory is 0, the following instruction is skipped. As this
requires the insertion of a dummy instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two
cycle instruction. If the result is not 0 the program proceeds with the following instruction.
Skip if [m]=0
None
Skip if Data Memory is 0 with data movement to ACC
The contents of the specified Data Memory are copied to the Accumulator. If the value is zero,
the following instruction is skipped. As this requires the insertion of a dummy instruction
while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle instruction. If the result is not 0 the
program proceeds with the following instruction.
ACC ← [m]
Skip if [m]=0
None
Skip if bit i of Data Memory is 0
If bit i of the specified Data Memory is 0, the following instruction is skipped. As this requires
the insertion of a dummy instruction while the next instruction is fetched, it is a two cycle
instruction. If the result is not 0, the program proceeds with the following instruction.
Skip if [m].i=0
None
196
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
TABRDC [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
TABRDL [m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
XOR A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
XORM A,[m]
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
XOR A,x
Description
Operation
Affected flag(s)
Rev. 1.00
Read table (current page) to TBLH and Data Memory
The low byte of the program code (current page) addressed by the table pointer (TBLP) is
moved to the specified Data Memory and the high byte moved to TBLH.
[m] ← program code (low byte)
TBLH ← program code (high byte)
None
Read table (last page) to TBLH and Data Memory
The low byte of the program code (last page) addressed by the table pointer (TBLP) is moved
to the specified Data Memory and the high byte moved to TBLH.
[m] ← program code (low byte)
TBLH ← program code (high byte)
None
Logical XOR Data Memory to ACC
Data in the Accumulator and the specified Data Memory perform a bitwise logical XOR
operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
ACC ← ACC ″XOR″ [m]
Z
Logical XOR ACC to Data Memory
Data in the specified Data Memory and the Accumulator perform a bitwise logical XOR
operation. The result is stored in the Data Memory.
[m] ← ACC ″XOR″ [m]
Z
Logical XOR immediate data to ACC
Data in the Accumulator and the specified immediate data perform a bitwise logical XOR
operation. The result is stored in the Accumulator.
ACC ← ACC ″XOR″ x
Z
197
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Package Information
Note that the package information provided here is for consultation purposes only. As this
information may be updated at regular intervals users are reminded to consult the Holtek website for
the latest version of the package information.
Additional supplementary information with regard to packaging is listed below. Click on the relevant
section to be transferred to the relevant website page.
• Further Package Information (include Outline Dimensions, Product Tape and Reel Specifications)
• Packing Meterials Information
• Carton information
• PB FREE Products
• Green Packages Products
Rev. 1.00
198
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
48-pin LQFP (7mm×7mm) Outline Dimensions
Symbol
Dimensions in inch
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
0.350
―
0.358
B
0.272
―
0.280
C
0.350
―
0.358
D
0.272
―
0.280
E
―
0.020
―
F
―
0.008
―
G
0.053
―
0.057
H
―
―
0.063
I
―
0.004
―
J
0.018
―
0.030
K
0.004
―
0.008
α
0°
―
7°
Symbol
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
8.90
―
9.10
B
6.90
―
7.10
C
8.90
―
9.10
D
6.90
―
7.10
E
―
0.50
―
F
―
0.20
―
G
1.35
―
1.45
H
―
―
1.60
I
―
0.10
―
J
0.45
―
0.75
K
0.10
―
0.20
α
0°
―
7°
199
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
64-pin LQFP (7mm×7mm) Outline Dimensions
Symbol
Nom.
Max.
A
0.350
―
0.358
B
0.272
―
0.280
C
0.350
―
0.358
D
0.272
―
0.280
E
―
0.016
―
F
0.005
―
0.009
G
0.053
―
0.057
H
―
―
0.063
I
0.002
―
0.006
J
0.018
―
0.030
K
0.004
―
0.008
α
0°
―
7°
Symbol
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in inch
Min.
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
A
8.90
―
9.10
B
6.90
―
7.10
C
8.90
―
9.10
D
6.90
―
7.10
E
―
0.40
―
F
0.13
―
0.23
G
1.35
―
1.45
H
―
―
1.60
I
0.05
―
0.15
J
0.45
―
0.75
K
0.09
―
0.20
α
0°
―
7°
200
March 19, 2013
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
TinyPowerTM I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
80-pin LQFP (10mm×10mm) Outline Dimensions
Symbol
Nom.
Max.
A
0.469
―
0.476
B
0.390
―
0.398
C
0.469
―
0.476
D
0.390
―
0.398
E
―
0.016
―
F
―
0.006
―
G
0.053
―
0.057
H
―
―
0.063
I
―
0.004
―
J
0.018
―
0.030
K
0.004
―
0.008
α
0°
―
7°
Symbol
A
Rev. 1.00
Dimensions in inch
Min.
Dimensions in mm
Min.
Nom.
Max.
11.90
―
12.10
B
9.90
―
10.10
C
11.90
―
12.10
D
9.90
―
10.10
E
―
0.40
―
F
―
0.16
―
G
1.35
―
1.45
H
―
―
1.60
I
―
0.10
―
J
0.45
―
0.75
K
0.10
―
0.20
α
0°
―
7°
201
March 19, 2013
TinyPower
TM
HT69F30A/HT69F40A/HT69F50A
I/O Flash 8-Bit MCU with LCD & EEPROM
Holtek Semiconductor Inc. (Headquarters)
No.3, Creation Rd. II, Science Park, Hsinchu, Taiwan
Tel: 886-3-563-1999
Fax: 886-3-563-1189
http://www.holtek.com.tw
Holtek Semiconductor Inc. (Taipei Sales Office)
4F-2, No. 3-2, YuanQu St., Nankang Software Park, Taipei 115, Taiwan
Tel: 886-2-2655-7070
Fax: 886-2-2655-7373
Fax: 886-2-2655-7383 (International sales hotline)
Holtek Semiconductor (China) Inc. (Dongguan Sales Office)
Building No.10, Xinzhu Court, (No.1 Headquarters), 4 Cuizhu Road, Songshan Lake, Dongguan, China 523808
Tel: 86-769-2626-1300
Fax: 86-769-2626-1311, 86-769-2626-1322
Holtek Semiconductor (USA), Inc. (North America Sales Office)
46729 Fremont Blvd., Fremont, CA 94538, USA
Tel: 1-510-252-9880
Fax: 1-510-252-9885
http://www.holtek.com
Copyright© 2013 by HOLTEK SEMICONDUCTOR INC.
The information appearing in this Data Sheet is believed to be accurate at the time of publication.
However, Holtek assumes no responsibility arising from the use of the specifications described.
The applications mentioned herein are used solely for the purpose of illustration and Holtek makes
no warranty or representation that such applications will be suitable without further modification,
nor recommends the use of its products for application that may present a risk to human life due to
malfunction or otherwise. Holtek's products are not authorized for use as critical components in life
support devices or systems. Holtek reserves the right to alter its products without prior notification. For
the most up-to-date information, please visit our web site at http://www.holtek.com.tw.
Rev. 1.00
202
March 19, 2013
Similar pages